blob: 61b7c5db8e17f2eec9206048a807fd68504c4aca [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00001//===--- ASTContext.cpp - Context to hold long-lived AST nodes ------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements the ASTContext interface.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Chandler Carruth3a022472012-12-04 09:13:33 +000015#include "CXXABI.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000016#include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
17#include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +000018#include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000019#include "clang/AST/Comment.h"
Dmitri Gribenkoca7f80a2012-08-09 00:03:17 +000020#include "clang/AST/CommentCommandTraits.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
Steve Naroff67391b82007-10-01 19:00:59 +000022#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorded2d7b2009-02-04 19:02:06 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +000024#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExternalASTSource.h"
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +000027#include "clang/AST/Mangle.h"
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +000028#include "clang/AST/MangleNumberingContext.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000029#include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h"
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +000030#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000031#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +000032#include "clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h"
Chris Lattner15ba9492009-06-14 01:54:56 +000033#include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
Chris Lattnerd2868512009-03-28 03:45:20 +000034#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner4dc8a6f2007-05-20 23:50:58 +000035#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000036#include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +000037#include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +000038#include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000039#include "llvm/Support/Capacity.h"
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +000040#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000041#include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +000042#include <map>
Anders Carlssona4267a62009-07-18 21:19:52 +000043
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +000044using namespace clang;
45
Douglas Gregor9672f922010-07-03 00:47:00 +000046unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructors;
47unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregora6d69502010-07-02 23:41:54 +000048unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructors;
49unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000050unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructors;
51unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor330b9cf2010-07-02 21:50:04 +000052unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators;
53unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000054unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators;
55unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +000056unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructors;
57unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared;
58
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000059enum FloatingRank {
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +000060 HalfRank, FloatRank, DoubleRank, LongDoubleRank
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000061};
62
Dmitri Gribenkof26054f2012-07-11 21:38:39 +000063RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl *D) const {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +000064 if (!CommentsLoaded && ExternalSource) {
65 ExternalSource->ReadComments();
Dmitri Gribenko9ee0e302014-03-27 15:40:39 +000066
67#ifndef NDEBUG
68 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
69 assert(std::is_sorted(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
70 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment>(SourceMgr)));
71#endif
72
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +000073 CommentsLoaded = true;
74 }
75
76 assert(D);
77
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +000078 // User can not attach documentation to implicit declarations.
79 if (D->isImplicit())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000080 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +000081
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +000082 // User can not attach documentation to implicit instantiations.
83 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
84 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000085 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +000086 }
87
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000088 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
89 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
90 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000091 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000092 }
93
94 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
95 if (CRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000096 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000097 }
98
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +000099 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
100 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
101 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = CTSD->getSpecializationKind();
102 if (TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
103 TSK == TSK_Undeclared)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000104 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000105 }
106
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000107 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
108 if (ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000109 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000110 }
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000111 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
112 // When tag declaration (but not definition!) is part of the
113 // decl-specifier-seq of some other declaration, it doesn't get comment
114 if (TD->isEmbeddedInDeclarator() && !TD->isCompleteDefinition())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000115 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000116 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000117 // TODO: handle comments for function parameters properly.
118 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000119 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000120
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000121 // TODO: we could look up template parameter documentation in the template
122 // documentation.
123 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(D) ||
124 isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D) ||
125 isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000126 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000127
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000128 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000129
130 // If there are no comments anywhere, we won't find anything.
131 if (RawComments.empty())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000132 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000133
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000134 // Find declaration location.
135 // For Objective-C declarations we generally don't expect to have multiple
136 // declarators, thus use declaration starting location as the "declaration
137 // location".
138 // For all other declarations multiple declarators are used quite frequently,
139 // so we use the location of the identifier as the "declaration location".
140 SourceLocation DeclLoc;
141 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000142 isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko7f4b3772012-08-02 20:49:51 +0000143 isa<RedeclarableTemplateDecl>(D) ||
144 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D))
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000145 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000146 else {
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000147 DeclLoc = D->getLocation();
Dmitri Gribenkoef099dc2014-03-27 16:40:51 +0000148 if (DeclLoc.isMacroID()) {
149 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
150 // If location of the typedef name is in a macro, it is because being
151 // declared via a macro. Try using declaration's starting location as
152 // the "declaration location".
153 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
154 } else if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
155 // If location of the tag decl is inside a macro, but the spelling of
156 // the tag name comes from a macro argument, it looks like a special
157 // macro like NS_ENUM is being used to define the tag decl. In that
158 // case, adjust the source location to the expansion loc so that we can
159 // attach the comment to the tag decl.
160 if (SourceMgr.isMacroArgExpansion(DeclLoc) &&
161 TD->isCompleteDefinition())
162 DeclLoc = SourceMgr.getExpansionLoc(DeclLoc);
163 }
164 }
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000165 }
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000166
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000167 // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we
168 // can't find the comment.
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000169 if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000170 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000171
172 // Find the comment that occurs just after this declaration.
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000173 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator Comment;
174 {
175 // When searching for comments during parsing, the comment we are looking
176 // for is usually among the last two comments we parsed -- check them
177 // first.
Dmitri Gribenkoa7d16ce2013-04-10 15:35:17 +0000178 RawComment CommentAtDeclLoc(
179 SourceMgr, SourceRange(DeclLoc), false,
180 LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments);
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000181 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment> Compare(SourceMgr);
182 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator MaybeBeforeDecl = RawComments.end() - 1;
183 bool Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
184 if (!Found && RawComments.size() >= 2) {
185 MaybeBeforeDecl--;
186 Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
187 }
188
189 if (Found) {
190 Comment = MaybeBeforeDecl + 1;
191 assert(Comment == std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
192 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare));
193 } else {
194 // Slow path.
195 Comment = std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
196 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare);
197 }
198 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000199
200 // Decompose the location for the declaration and find the beginning of the
201 // file buffer.
202 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DeclLocDecomp = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(DeclLoc);
203
204 // First check whether we have a trailing comment.
205 if (Comment != RawComments.end() &&
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000206 (*Comment)->isDocumentation() && (*Comment)->isTrailingComment() &&
Fariborz Jahanianfad28542013-08-06 23:29:00 +0000207 (isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D) ||
Fariborz Jahanian3ab62222013-08-07 16:40:29 +0000208 isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D))) {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000209 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentBeginDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000210 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getBegin());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000211 // Check that Doxygen trailing comment comes after the declaration, starts
212 // on the same line and in the same file as the declaration.
213 if (DeclLocDecomp.first == CommentBeginDecomp.first &&
214 SourceMgr.getLineNumber(DeclLocDecomp.first, DeclLocDecomp.second)
215 == SourceMgr.getLineNumber(CommentBeginDecomp.first,
216 CommentBeginDecomp.second)) {
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000217 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000218 }
219 }
220
221 // The comment just after the declaration was not a trailing comment.
222 // Let's look at the previous comment.
223 if (Comment == RawComments.begin())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000224 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000225 --Comment;
226
227 // Check that we actually have a non-member Doxygen comment.
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000228 if (!(*Comment)->isDocumentation() || (*Comment)->isTrailingComment())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000229 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000230
231 // Decompose the end of the comment.
232 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentEndDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000233 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000234
235 // If the comment and the declaration aren't in the same file, then they
236 // aren't related.
237 if (DeclLocDecomp.first != CommentEndDecomp.first)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000238 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000239
240 // Get the corresponding buffer.
241 bool Invalid = false;
242 const char *Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(DeclLocDecomp.first,
243 &Invalid).data();
244 if (Invalid)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000245 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000246
247 // Extract text between the comment and declaration.
248 StringRef Text(Buffer + CommentEndDecomp.second,
249 DeclLocDecomp.second - CommentEndDecomp.second);
250
Dmitri Gribenko7e8729b2012-06-27 23:43:37 +0000251 // There should be no other declarations or preprocessor directives between
252 // comment and declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb534d3a2013-07-26 18:38:12 +0000253 if (Text.find_first_of(";{}#@") != StringRef::npos)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000254 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000255
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000256 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000257}
258
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000259namespace {
260/// If we have a 'templated' declaration for a template, adjust 'D' to
261/// refer to the actual template.
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000262/// If we have an implicit instantiation, adjust 'D' to refer to template.
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000263const Decl *adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl *D) {
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000264 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000265 // Is this function declaration part of a function template?
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000266 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000267 return FTD;
268
269 // Nothing to do if function is not an implicit instantiation.
270 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
271 return D;
272
273 // Function is an implicit instantiation of a function template?
274 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getPrimaryTemplate())
275 return FTD;
276
277 // Function is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
278 if (const FunctionDecl *MemberDecl =
279 FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction())
280 return MemberDecl;
281
282 return D;
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000283 }
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000284 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
285 // Static data member is instantiated from a member definition of a class
286 // template?
287 if (VD->isStaticDataMember())
288 if (const VarDecl *MemberDecl = VD->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember())
289 return MemberDecl;
290
291 return D;
292 }
293 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
294 // Is this class declaration part of a class template?
295 if (const ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = CRD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
296 return CTD;
297
298 // Class is an implicit instantiation of a class template or partial
299 // specialization?
300 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
301 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CRD)) {
302 if (CTSD->getSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
303 return D;
304 llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl *,
305 ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>
306 PU = CTSD->getSpecializedTemplateOrPartial();
307 return PU.is<ClassTemplateDecl*>() ?
308 static_cast<const Decl*>(PU.get<ClassTemplateDecl *>()) :
309 static_cast<const Decl*>(
310 PU.get<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>());
311 }
312
313 // Class is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
314 if (const MemberSpecializationInfo *Info =
315 CRD->getMemberSpecializationInfo())
316 return Info->getInstantiatedFrom();
317
318 return D;
319 }
320 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
321 // Enum is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
322 if (const EnumDecl *MemberDecl = ED->getInstantiatedFromMemberEnum())
323 return MemberDecl;
324
325 return D;
326 }
327 // FIXME: Adjust alias templates?
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000328 return D;
329}
330} // unnamed namespace
331
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000332const RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(
333 const Decl *D,
334 const Decl **OriginalDecl) const {
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000335 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000336
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000337 // Check whether we have cached a comment for this declaration already.
338 {
339 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
340 RedeclComments.find(D);
341 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
342 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000343 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
344 if (OriginalDecl)
345 *OriginalDecl = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000346 return Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000347 }
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000348 }
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000349 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000350
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000351 // Search for comments attached to declarations in the redeclaration chain.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000352 const RawComment *RC = nullptr;
353 const Decl *OriginalDeclForRC = nullptr;
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000354 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000355 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000356 RedeclComments.find(I);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000357 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
358 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
359 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
360 RC = Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000361 OriginalDeclForRC = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000362 break;
363 }
364 } else {
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000365 RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(I);
366 OriginalDeclForRC = I;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000367 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
368 if (RC) {
369 Raw.setRaw(RC);
370 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromDecl);
371 } else
372 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl);
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000373 Raw.setOriginalDecl(I);
374 RedeclComments[I] = Raw;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000375 if (RC)
376 break;
377 }
378 }
379
Dmitri Gribenko5c8897d2012-06-28 16:25:36 +0000380 // If we found a comment, it should be a documentation comment.
381 assert(!RC || RC->isDocumentation());
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000382
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000383 if (OriginalDecl)
384 *OriginalDecl = OriginalDeclForRC;
385
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000386 // Update cache for every declaration in the redeclaration chain.
387 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
388 Raw.setRaw(RC);
389 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromRedecl);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000390 Raw.setOriginalDecl(OriginalDeclForRC);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000391
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000392 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
393 RawCommentAndCacheFlags &R = RedeclComments[I];
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000394 if (R.getKind() == RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl)
395 R = Raw;
396 }
397
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000398 return RC;
399}
400
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000401static void addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl *ObjCMethod,
402 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Redeclared) {
403 const DeclContext *DC = ObjCMethod->getDeclContext();
404 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(DC)) {
405 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = IMD->getClassInterface();
406 if (!ID)
407 return;
408 // Add redeclared method here.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +0000409 for (const auto *Ext : ID->known_extensions()) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000410 if (ObjCMethodDecl *RedeclaredMethod =
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +0000411 Ext->getMethod(ObjCMethod->getSelector(),
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000412 ObjCMethod->isInstanceMethod()))
413 Redeclared.push_back(RedeclaredMethod);
414 }
415 }
416}
417
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000418comments::FullComment *ASTContext::cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment *FC,
419 const Decl *D) const {
420 comments::DeclInfo *ThisDeclInfo = new (*this) comments::DeclInfo;
421 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = D;
422 ThisDeclInfo->IsFilled = false;
423 ThisDeclInfo->fill();
424 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = FC->getDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7daabbd2014-04-27 22:53:03 +0000425 if (!ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters)
426 ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters = FC->getDeclInfo()->TemplateParameters;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000427 comments::FullComment *CFC =
428 new (*this) comments::FullComment(FC->getBlocks(),
429 ThisDeclInfo);
430 return CFC;
431
432}
433
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000434comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl *D) const {
435 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(D);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000436 return RC ? RC->parse(*this, nullptr, D) : nullptr;
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000437}
438
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000439comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getCommentForDecl(
440 const Decl *D,
441 const Preprocessor *PP) const {
Fariborz Jahanian096f7c12013-05-13 17:27:00 +0000442 if (D->isInvalidDecl())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000443 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000444 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000445
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000446 const Decl *Canonical = D->getCanonicalDecl();
447 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, comments::FullComment *>::iterator Pos =
448 ParsedComments.find(Canonical);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000449
450 if (Pos != ParsedComments.end()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000451 if (Canonical != D) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000452 comments::FullComment *FC = Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000453 comments::FullComment *CFC = cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000454 return CFC;
455 }
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000456 return Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000457 }
458
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000459 const Decl *OriginalDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000460
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000461 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D, &OriginalDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000462 if (!RC) {
463 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000464 SmallVector<const NamedDecl*, 8> Overridden;
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000465 const ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000466 if (OMD && OMD->isPropertyAccessor())
467 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = OMD->findPropertyDecl())
468 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(PDecl, PP))
469 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000470 if (OMD)
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000471 addRedeclaredMethods(OMD, Overridden);
472 getOverriddenMethods(dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D), Overridden);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000473 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Overridden.size(); i < e; i++)
474 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(Overridden[i], PP))
475 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000476 }
Fariborz Jahanian6384fbb2013-05-02 15:44:16 +0000477 else if (const TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000478 // Attach any tag type's documentation to its typedef if latter
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000479 // does not have one of its own.
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000480 QualType QT = TD->getUnderlyingType();
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000481 if (const TagType *TT = QT->getAs<TagType>())
482 if (const Decl *TD = TT->getDecl())
483 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(TD, PP))
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000484 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000485 }
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000486 else if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
487 while (IC->getSuperClass()) {
488 IC = IC->getSuperClass();
489 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
490 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
491 }
492 }
493 else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)) {
494 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = CD->getClassInterface())
495 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
496 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
497 }
498 else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
499 if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000500 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000501 // Check non-virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000502 for (const auto &I : RD->bases()) {
503 if (I.isVirtual() || (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public))
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000504 continue;
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000505 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000506 if (Ty.isNull())
507 continue;
508 if (const CXXRecordDecl *NonVirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
509 if (!(NonVirtualBase= NonVirtualBase->getDefinition()))
510 continue;
511
512 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((NonVirtualBase), PP))
513 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
514 }
515 }
516 // Check virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000517 for (const auto &I : RD->vbases()) {
518 if (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public)
Fariborz Jahanian5a2e4a22013-04-26 23:34:36 +0000519 continue;
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000520 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000521 if (Ty.isNull())
522 continue;
523 if (const CXXRecordDecl *VirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
524 if (!(VirtualBase= VirtualBase->getDefinition()))
525 continue;
526 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((VirtualBase), PP))
527 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
528 }
529 }
530 }
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000531 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000532 }
533
Dmitri Gribenkobfda9f72012-08-22 18:12:19 +0000534 // If the RawComment was attached to other redeclaration of this Decl, we
535 // should parse the comment in context of that other Decl. This is important
536 // because comments can contain references to parameter names which can be
537 // different across redeclarations.
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000538 if (D != OriginalDecl)
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000539 return getCommentForDecl(OriginalDecl, PP);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000540
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000541 comments::FullComment *FC = RC->parse(*this, PP, D);
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000542 ParsedComments[Canonical] = FC;
543 return FC;
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000544}
545
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000546void
547ASTContext::CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
548 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Parm) {
549 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getDepth());
550 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getPosition());
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000551 ID.AddBoolean(Parm->isParameterPack());
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000552
553 TemplateParameterList *Params = Parm->getTemplateParameters();
554 ID.AddInteger(Params->size());
555 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
556 PEnd = Params->end();
557 P != PEnd; ++P) {
558 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) {
559 ID.AddInteger(0);
560 ID.AddBoolean(TTP->isParameterPack());
561 continue;
562 }
563
564 if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
565 ID.AddInteger(1);
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000566 ID.AddBoolean(NTTP->isParameterPack());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000567 ID.AddPointer(NTTP->getType().getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000568 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
569 ID.AddBoolean(true);
570 ID.AddInteger(NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000571 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
572 QualType T = NTTP->getExpansionType(I);
573 ID.AddPointer(T.getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
574 }
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000575 } else
576 ID.AddBoolean(false);
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000577 continue;
578 }
579
580 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P);
581 ID.AddInteger(2);
582 Profile(ID, TTP);
583 }
584}
585
586TemplateTemplateParmDecl *
587ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +0000588 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP) const {
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000589 // Check if we already have a canonical template template parameter.
590 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
591 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(ID, TTP);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000592 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000593 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm *Canonical
594 = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
595 if (Canonical)
596 return Canonical->getParam();
597
598 // Build a canonical template parameter list.
599 TemplateParameterList *Params = TTP->getTemplateParameters();
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000600 SmallVector<NamedDecl *, 4> CanonParams;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000601 CanonParams.reserve(Params->size());
602 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
603 PEnd = Params->end();
604 P != PEnd; ++P) {
605 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P))
606 CanonParams.push_back(
607 TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnarab3185b02011-03-06 15:48:19 +0000608 SourceLocation(),
609 SourceLocation(),
610 TTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000611 TTP->getIndex(), nullptr, false,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000612 TTP->isParameterPack()));
613 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000614 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
615 QualType T = getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType());
616 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
617 NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param;
618 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000619 SmallVector<QualType, 2> ExpandedTypes;
620 SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 2> ExpandedTInfos;
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000621 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
622 ExpandedTypes.push_back(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getExpansionType(I)));
623 ExpandedTInfos.push_back(
624 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ExpandedTypes.back()));
625 }
626
627 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000628 SourceLocation(),
629 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000630 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000631 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000632 T,
633 TInfo,
634 ExpandedTypes.data(),
635 ExpandedTypes.size(),
636 ExpandedTInfos.data());
637 } else {
638 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000639 SourceLocation(),
640 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000641 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000642 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000643 T,
644 NTTP->isParameterPack(),
645 TInfo);
646 }
647 CanonParams.push_back(Param);
648
649 } else
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000650 CanonParams.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
651 cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P)));
652 }
653
654 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *CanonTTP
655 = TemplateTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
656 SourceLocation(), TTP->getDepth(),
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000657 TTP->getPosition(),
658 TTP->isParameterPack(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000659 nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000660 TemplateParameterList::Create(*this, SourceLocation(),
661 SourceLocation(),
662 CanonParams.data(),
663 CanonParams.size(),
664 SourceLocation()));
665
666 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
667 Canonical = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000668 assert(!Canonical && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000669 (void)Canonical;
670
671 // Create the canonical template template parameter entry.
672 Canonical = new (*this) CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm(CanonTTP);
673 CanonTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(Canonical, InsertPos);
674 return CanonTTP;
675}
676
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000677CXXABI *ASTContext::createCXXABI(const TargetInfo &T) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000678 if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus) return nullptr;
John McCall86353412010-08-21 22:46:04 +0000679
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000680 switch (T.getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000681 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM: // Same as Itanium at this level
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000682 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +0000683 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000684 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
Zoran Jovanovic26a12162015-02-18 15:21:35 +0000685 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000686 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000687 return CreateItaniumCXXABI(*this);
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000688 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Charles Davis6bcb07a2010-08-19 02:18:14 +0000689 return CreateMicrosoftCXXABI(*this);
690 }
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +0000691 llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXXABI type!");
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000692}
693
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000694static const LangAS::Map *getAddressSpaceMap(const TargetInfo &T,
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000695 const LangOptions &LOpts) {
696 if (LOpts.FakeAddressSpaceMap) {
697 // The fake address space map must have a distinct entry for each
698 // language-specific address space.
699 static const unsigned FakeAddrSpaceMap[] = {
700 1, // opencl_global
701 2, // opencl_local
Peter Collingbournef44bdf92012-05-20 21:08:35 +0000702 3, // opencl_constant
Anastasia Stulova2c8dcfb2014-11-26 14:10:06 +0000703 4, // opencl_generic
704 5, // cuda_device
705 6, // cuda_constant
706 7 // cuda_shared
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000707 };
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000708 return &FakeAddrSpaceMap;
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000709 } else {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000710 return &T.getAddressSpaceMap();
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000711 }
712}
713
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000714static bool isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(const TargetInfo &TI,
715 const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
716 switch (LangOpts.getAddressSpaceMapMangling()) {
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000717 case LangOptions::ASMM_Target:
718 return TI.useAddressSpaceMapMangling();
719 case LangOptions::ASMM_On:
720 return true;
721 case LangOptions::ASMM_Off:
722 return false;
723 }
NAKAMURA Takumi5c81ca42013-09-13 17:12:09 +0000724 llvm_unreachable("getAddressSpaceMapMangling() doesn't cover anything.");
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000725}
726
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000727ASTContext::ASTContext(LangOptions &LOpts, SourceManager &SM,
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000728 IdentifierTable &idents, SelectorTable &sels,
Alp Toker08043432014-05-03 03:46:04 +0000729 Builtin::Context &builtins)
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000730 : FunctionProtoTypes(this_()), TemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
731 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
732 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks(this_()),
733 GlobalNestedNameSpecifier(nullptr), Int128Decl(nullptr),
734 UInt128Decl(nullptr), Float128StubDecl(nullptr),
735 BuiltinVaListDecl(nullptr), ObjCIdDecl(nullptr), ObjCSelDecl(nullptr),
736 ObjCClassDecl(nullptr), ObjCProtocolClassDecl(nullptr), BOOLDecl(nullptr),
737 CFConstantStringTypeDecl(nullptr), ObjCInstanceTypeDecl(nullptr),
738 FILEDecl(nullptr), jmp_bufDecl(nullptr), sigjmp_bufDecl(nullptr),
739 ucontext_tDecl(nullptr), BlockDescriptorType(nullptr),
740 BlockDescriptorExtendedType(nullptr), cudaConfigureCallDecl(nullptr),
Richard Smithf19e1272015-03-07 00:04:49 +0000741 FirstLocalImport(), LastLocalImport(), ExternCContext(nullptr),
742 SourceMgr(SM), LangOpts(LOpts),
Alexey Samsonova511cdd2015-02-04 17:40:08 +0000743 SanitizerBL(new SanitizerBlacklist(LangOpts.SanitizerBlacklistFiles, SM)),
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000744 AddrSpaceMap(nullptr), Target(nullptr), PrintingPolicy(LOpts),
745 Idents(idents), Selectors(sels), BuiltinInfo(builtins),
746 DeclarationNames(*this), ExternalSource(nullptr), Listener(nullptr),
747 Comments(SM), CommentsLoaded(false),
748 CommentCommandTraits(BumpAlloc, LOpts.CommentOpts), LastSDM(nullptr, 0) {
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000749 TUDecl = TranslationUnitDecl::Create(*this);
750}
751
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000752ASTContext::~ASTContext() {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000753 ReleaseParentMapEntries();
754
Ted Kremenekda4e0d32010-02-11 07:12:28 +0000755 // Release the DenseMaps associated with DeclContext objects.
756 // FIXME: Is this the ideal solution?
757 ReleaseDeclContextMaps();
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +0000758
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000759 // Call all of the deallocation functions on all of their targets.
760 for (DeallocationMap::const_iterator I = Deallocations.begin(),
761 E = Deallocations.end(); I != E; ++I)
762 for (unsigned J = 0, N = I->second.size(); J != N; ++J)
763 (I->first)((I->second)[J]);
764
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000765 // ASTRecordLayout objects in ASTRecordLayouts must always be destroyed
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000766 // because they can contain DenseMaps.
767 for (llvm::DenseMap<const ObjCContainerDecl*,
768 const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
769 I = ObjCLayouts.begin(), E = ObjCLayouts.end(); I != E; )
770 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
771 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
772 R->Destroy(*this);
773
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000774 for (llvm::DenseMap<const RecordDecl*, const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
775 I = ASTRecordLayouts.begin(), E = ASTRecordLayouts.end(); I != E; ) {
776 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
777 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
778 R->Destroy(*this);
779 }
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000780
781 for (llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator A = DeclAttrs.begin(),
782 AEnd = DeclAttrs.end();
783 A != AEnd; ++A)
784 A->second->~AttrVec();
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +0000785
Reid Kleckner588c9372014-02-19 23:44:52 +0000786 llvm::DeleteContainerSeconds(MangleNumberingContexts);
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000787}
Douglas Gregorf21eb492009-03-26 23:50:42 +0000788
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000789void ASTContext::ReleaseParentMapEntries() {
790 if (!AllParents) return;
791 for (const auto &Entry : *AllParents) {
792 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
793 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
794 } else {
795 assert(Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>());
796 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>();
797 }
798 }
799}
800
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000801void ASTContext::AddDeallocation(void (*Callback)(void*), void *Data) {
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000802 Deallocations[Callback].push_back(Data);
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000803}
804
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000805void
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000806ASTContext::setExternalSource(IntrusiveRefCntPtr<ExternalASTSource> Source) {
807 ExternalSource = Source;
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000808}
809
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000810void ASTContext::PrintStats() const {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000811 llvm::errs() << "\n*** AST Context Stats:\n";
812 llvm::errs() << " " << Types.size() << " types total.\n";
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +0000813
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000814 unsigned counts[] = {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000815#define TYPE(Name, Parent) 0,
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000816#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
817#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
818 0 // Extra
819 };
Douglas Gregorb1fe2c92009-04-07 17:20:56 +0000820
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000821 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Types.size(); i != e; ++i) {
822 Type *T = Types[i];
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000823 counts[(unsigned)T->getTypeClass()]++;
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000824 }
825
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000826 unsigned Idx = 0;
827 unsigned TotalBytes = 0;
828#define TYPE(Name, Parent) \
829 if (counts[Idx]) \
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000830 llvm::errs() << " " << counts[Idx] << " " << #Name \
831 << " types\n"; \
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000832 TotalBytes += counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type); \
833 ++Idx;
834#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
835#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000836
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000837 llvm::errs() << "Total bytes = " << TotalBytes << "\n";
838
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +0000839 // Implicit special member functions.
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000840 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared << "/"
841 << NumImplicitDefaultConstructors
842 << " implicit default constructors created\n";
843 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared << "/"
844 << NumImplicitCopyConstructors
845 << " implicit copy constructors created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000846 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000847 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared << "/"
848 << NumImplicitMoveConstructors
849 << " implicit move constructors created\n";
850 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
851 << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators
852 << " implicit copy assignment operators created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000853 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000854 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
855 << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators
856 << " implicit move assignment operators created\n";
857 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared << "/"
858 << NumImplicitDestructors
859 << " implicit destructors created\n";
860
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000861 if (ExternalSource) {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000862 llvm::errs() << "\n";
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000863 ExternalSource->PrintStats();
864 }
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000865
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000866 BumpAlloc.PrintStats();
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000867}
868
Richard Smith42413142015-05-15 20:05:43 +0000869void ASTContext::mergeDefinitionIntoModule(NamedDecl *ND, Module *M,
870 bool NotifyListeners) {
871 if (NotifyListeners)
872 if (auto *Listener = getASTMutationListener())
873 Listener->RedefinedHiddenDefinition(ND, M);
874
875 if (getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility)
876 MergedDefModules[ND].push_back(M);
877 else
878 ND->setHidden(false);
879}
880
881void ASTContext::deduplicateMergedDefinitonsFor(NamedDecl *ND) {
882 auto It = MergedDefModules.find(ND);
883 if (It == MergedDefModules.end())
884 return;
885
886 auto &Merged = It->second;
887 llvm::DenseSet<Module*> Found;
888 for (Module *&M : Merged)
889 if (!Found.insert(M).second)
890 M = nullptr;
891 Merged.erase(std::remove(Merged.begin(), Merged.end(), nullptr), Merged.end());
892}
893
Richard Smithf19e1272015-03-07 00:04:49 +0000894ExternCContextDecl *ASTContext::getExternCContextDecl() const {
895 if (!ExternCContext)
896 ExternCContext = ExternCContextDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl());
897
898 return ExternCContext;
899}
900
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000901RecordDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitRecord(StringRef Name,
902 RecordDecl::TagKind TK) const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000903 SourceLocation Loc;
904 RecordDecl *NewDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000905 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
906 NewDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc,
907 Loc, &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000908 else
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000909 NewDecl = RecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc, Loc,
910 &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000911 NewDecl->setImplicit();
David Majnemerf8637362015-01-15 08:41:25 +0000912 NewDecl->addAttr(TypeVisibilityAttr::CreateImplicit(
913 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), TypeVisibilityAttr::Default));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000914 return NewDecl;
915}
916
917TypedefDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitTypedef(QualType T,
918 StringRef Name) const {
919 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
920 TypedefDecl *NewDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(
921 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), getTranslationUnitDecl(),
922 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), &Idents.get(Name), TInfo);
923 NewDecl->setImplicit();
924 return NewDecl;
925}
926
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000927TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000928 if (!Int128Decl)
929 Int128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(Int128Ty, "__int128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000930 return Int128Decl;
931}
932
933TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getUInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000934 if (!UInt128Decl)
935 UInt128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(UnsignedInt128Ty, "__uint128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000936 return UInt128Decl;
937}
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000938
Nico Webere1687c52013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000939TypeDecl *ASTContext::getFloat128StubType() const {
Nico Weber5b0b46f2013-06-21 01:29:36 +0000940 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus && "should only be called for c++");
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000941 if (!Float128StubDecl)
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000942 Float128StubDecl = buildImplicitRecord("__float128");
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000943
Nico Webere1687c52013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000944 return Float128StubDecl;
945}
946
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000947void ASTContext::InitBuiltinType(CanQualType &R, BuiltinType::Kind K) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000948 BuiltinType *Ty = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BuiltinType(K);
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000949 R = CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(QualType(Ty, 0));
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000950 Types.push_back(Ty);
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000951}
952
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000953void ASTContext::InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo &Target) {
954 assert((!this->Target || this->Target == &Target) &&
955 "Incorrect target reinitialization");
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000956 assert(VoidTy.isNull() && "Context reinitialized?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000957
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000958 this->Target = &Target;
959
960 ABI.reset(createCXXABI(Target));
961 AddrSpaceMap = getAddressSpaceMap(Target, LangOpts);
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000962 AddrSpaceMapMangling = isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(Target, LangOpts);
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000963
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000964 // C99 6.2.5p19.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000965 InitBuiltinType(VoidTy, BuiltinType::Void);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000966
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000967 // C99 6.2.5p2.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000968 InitBuiltinType(BoolTy, BuiltinType::Bool);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000969 // C99 6.2.5p3.
Eli Friedman9ffd4a92009-06-05 07:05:05 +0000970 if (LangOpts.CharIsSigned)
Chris Lattnerb16f4552007-06-03 07:25:34 +0000971 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_S);
972 else
973 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_U);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000974 // C99 6.2.5p4.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000975 InitBuiltinType(SignedCharTy, BuiltinType::SChar);
976 InitBuiltinType(ShortTy, BuiltinType::Short);
977 InitBuiltinType(IntTy, BuiltinType::Int);
978 InitBuiltinType(LongTy, BuiltinType::Long);
979 InitBuiltinType(LongLongTy, BuiltinType::LongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000980
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000981 // C99 6.2.5p6.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000982 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedCharTy, BuiltinType::UChar);
983 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortTy, BuiltinType::UShort);
984 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedIntTy, BuiltinType::UInt);
985 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongTy, BuiltinType::ULong);
986 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongLongTy, BuiltinType::ULongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000987
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000988 // C99 6.2.5p10.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000989 InitBuiltinType(FloatTy, BuiltinType::Float);
990 InitBuiltinType(DoubleTy, BuiltinType::Double);
991 InitBuiltinType(LongDoubleTy, BuiltinType::LongDouble);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +0000992
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +0000993 // GNU extension, 128-bit integers.
994 InitBuiltinType(Int128Ty, BuiltinType::Int128);
995 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedInt128Ty, BuiltinType::UInt128);
996
Hans Wennborg0d81e012013-05-10 10:08:40 +0000997 // C++ 3.9.1p5
998 if (TargetInfo::isTypeSigned(Target.getWCharType()))
999 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_S);
1000 else // -fshort-wchar makes wchar_t be unsigned.
1001 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_U);
1002 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && LangOpts.WChar)
1003 WideCharTy = WCharTy;
1004 else {
1005 // C99 (or C++ using -fno-wchar).
1006 WideCharTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWCharType());
1007 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001008
James Molloy36365542012-05-04 10:55:22 +00001009 WIntTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWIntType());
1010
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001011 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1012 InitBuiltinType(Char16Ty, BuiltinType::Char16);
1013 else // C99
1014 Char16Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar16Type());
1015
1016 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1017 InitBuiltinType(Char32Ty, BuiltinType::Char32);
1018 else // C99
1019 Char32Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar32Type());
1020
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001021 // Placeholder type for type-dependent expressions whose type is
1022 // completely unknown. No code should ever check a type against
1023 // DependentTy and users should never see it; however, it is here to
1024 // help diagnose failures to properly check for type-dependent
1025 // expressions.
1026 InitBuiltinType(DependentTy, BuiltinType::Dependent);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001027
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00001028 // Placeholder type for functions.
1029 InitBuiltinType(OverloadTy, BuiltinType::Overload);
1030
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00001031 // Placeholder type for bound members.
1032 InitBuiltinType(BoundMemberTy, BuiltinType::BoundMember);
1033
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001034 // Placeholder type for pseudo-objects.
1035 InitBuiltinType(PseudoObjectTy, BuiltinType::PseudoObject);
1036
John McCall31996342011-04-07 08:22:57 +00001037 // "any" type; useful for debugger-like clients.
1038 InitBuiltinType(UnknownAnyTy, BuiltinType::UnknownAny);
1039
John McCall8a6b59a2011-10-17 18:09:15 +00001040 // Placeholder type for unbridged ARC casts.
1041 InitBuiltinType(ARCUnbridgedCastTy, BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast);
1042
Eli Friedman34866c72012-08-31 00:14:07 +00001043 // Placeholder type for builtin functions.
1044 InitBuiltinType(BuiltinFnTy, BuiltinType::BuiltinFn);
1045
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001046 // C99 6.2.5p11.
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00001047 FloatComplexTy = getComplexType(FloatTy);
1048 DoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(DoubleTy);
1049 LongDoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(LongDoubleTy);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001050
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001051 // Builtin types for 'id', 'Class', and 'SEL'.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001052 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, BuiltinType::ObjCId);
1053 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, BuiltinType::ObjCClass);
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001054 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy, BuiltinType::ObjCSel);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001055
1056 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
1057 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1d);
1058 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray);
1059 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dBufferTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer);
1060 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2d);
1061 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray);
1062 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage3dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage3d);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001063
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001064 InitBuiltinType(OCLSamplerTy, BuiltinType::OCLSampler);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001065 InitBuiltinType(OCLEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLEvent);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001066 }
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001067
1068 // Builtin type for __objc_yes and __objc_no
Fariborz Jahanian29898f42012-04-16 21:03:30 +00001069 ObjCBuiltinBoolTy = (Target.useSignedCharForObjCBool() ?
1070 SignedCharTy : BoolTy);
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001071
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00001072 ObjCConstantStringType = QualType();
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00001073
1074 ObjCSuperType = QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001075
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00001076 // void * type
1077 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(VoidTy);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001078
1079 // nullptr type (C++0x 2.14.7)
1080 InitBuiltinType(NullPtrTy, BuiltinType::NullPtr);
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001081
1082 // half type (OpenCL 6.1.1.1) / ARM NEON __fp16
1083 InitBuiltinType(HalfTy, BuiltinType::Half);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00001084
1085 // Builtin type used to help define __builtin_va_list.
1086 VaListTagTy = QualType();
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001087}
1088
David Blaikie9c902b52011-09-25 23:23:43 +00001089DiagnosticsEngine &ASTContext::getDiagnostics() const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisca0d0cd2010-09-22 14:32:24 +00001090 return SourceMgr.getDiagnostics();
1091}
1092
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +00001093AttrVec& ASTContext::getDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1094 AttrVec *&Result = DeclAttrs[D];
1095 if (!Result) {
1096 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AttrVec));
1097 Result = new (Mem) AttrVec;
1098 }
1099
1100 return *Result;
1101}
1102
1103/// \brief Erase the attributes corresponding to the given declaration.
1104void ASTContext::eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1105 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator Pos = DeclAttrs.find(D);
1106 if (Pos != DeclAttrs.end()) {
1107 Pos->second->~AttrVec();
1108 DeclAttrs.erase(Pos);
1109 }
1110}
1111
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001112// FIXME: Remove ?
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001113MemberSpecializationInfo *
Douglas Gregor3c74d412009-10-14 20:14:33 +00001114ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl *Var) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001115 assert(Var->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001116 return getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Var)
1117 .dyn_cast<MemberSpecializationInfo *>();
1118}
1119
1120ASTContext::TemplateOrSpecializationInfo
1121ASTContext::getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl *Var) {
1122 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, TemplateOrSpecializationInfo>::iterator Pos =
1123 TemplateOrInstantiation.find(Var);
1124 if (Pos == TemplateOrInstantiation.end())
1125 return TemplateOrSpecializationInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001126
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001127 return Pos->second;
1128}
1129
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001130void
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001131ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl *Inst, VarDecl *Tmpl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscdb8b3f2010-07-04 21:44:00 +00001132 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
1133 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001134 assert(Inst->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1135 assert(Tmpl->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001136 setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Inst, new (*this) MemberSpecializationInfo(
1137 Tmpl, TSK, PointOfInstantiation));
1138}
1139
1140void
1141ASTContext::setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl *Inst,
1142 TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI) {
1143 assert(!TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] &&
1144 "Already noted what the variable was instantiated from");
1145 TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] = TSI;
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001146}
1147
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001148FunctionDecl *ASTContext::getClassScopeSpecializationPattern(
1149 const FunctionDecl *FD){
1150 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1151 llvm::DenseMap<const FunctionDecl*, FunctionDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001152 = ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.find(FD);
1153 if (Pos == ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001154 return nullptr;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001155
1156 return Pos->second;
1157}
1158
1159void ASTContext::setClassScopeSpecializationPattern(FunctionDecl *FD,
1160 FunctionDecl *Pattern) {
1161 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1162 assert(Pattern && "Class scope specialization pattern is 0");
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001163 ClassScopeSpecializationPattern[FD] = Pattern;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001164}
1165
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001166NamedDecl *
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001167ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *UUD) {
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001168 llvm::DenseMap<UsingDecl *, NamedDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001169 = InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.find(UUD);
1170 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001171 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001172
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001173 return Pos->second;
1174}
1175
1176void
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001177ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *Inst, NamedDecl *Pattern) {
1178 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Pattern) ||
1179 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Pattern) ||
1180 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Pattern)) &&
1181 "pattern decl is not a using decl");
1182 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1183 InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1184}
1185
1186UsingShadowDecl *
1187ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst) {
1188 llvm::DenseMap<UsingShadowDecl*, UsingShadowDecl*>::const_iterator Pos
1189 = InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.find(Inst);
1190 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001191 return nullptr;
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001192
1193 return Pos->second;
1194}
1195
1196void
1197ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst,
1198 UsingShadowDecl *Pattern) {
1199 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1200 InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001201}
1202
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001203FieldDecl *ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Field) {
1204 llvm::DenseMap<FieldDecl *, FieldDecl *>::iterator Pos
1205 = InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.find(Field);
1206 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001207 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001208
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001209 return Pos->second;
1210}
1211
1212void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Inst,
1213 FieldDecl *Tmpl) {
1214 assert(!Inst->getDeclName() && "Instantiated field decl is not unnamed");
1215 assert(!Tmpl->getDeclName() && "Template field decl is not unnamed");
1216 assert(!InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] &&
1217 "Already noted what unnamed field was instantiated from");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001218
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001219 InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] = Tmpl;
1220}
1221
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001222ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1223ASTContext::overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1224 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001225 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001226 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001227 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001228
1229 return Pos->second.begin();
1230}
1231
1232ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1233ASTContext::overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1234 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001235 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001236 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001237 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001238
1239 return Pos->second.end();
1240}
1241
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001242unsigned
1243ASTContext::overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1244 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001245 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001246 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1247 return 0;
1248
1249 return Pos->second.size();
1250}
1251
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001252void ASTContext::addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *Method,
1253 const CXXMethodDecl *Overridden) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001254 assert(Method->isCanonicalDecl() && Overridden->isCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001255 OverriddenMethods[Method].push_back(Overridden);
1256}
1257
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +00001258void ASTContext::getOverriddenMethods(
1259 const NamedDecl *D,
1260 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Overridden) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001261 assert(D);
1262
1263 if (const CXXMethodDecl *CXXMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc8e70082013-04-17 00:09:03 +00001264 Overridden.append(overridden_methods_begin(CXXMethod),
1265 overridden_methods_end(CXXMethod));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001266 return;
1267 }
1268
1269 const ObjCMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
1270 if (!Method)
1271 return;
1272
Argyrios Kyrtzidis353f6a42012-10-09 18:19:01 +00001273 SmallVector<const ObjCMethodDecl *, 8> OverDecls;
1274 Method->getOverriddenMethods(OverDecls);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa7a10812012-10-09 20:08:43 +00001275 Overridden.append(OverDecls.begin(), OverDecls.end());
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001276}
1277
Douglas Gregor0f2a3602011-12-03 00:30:27 +00001278void ASTContext::addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl *Import) {
1279 assert(!Import->NextLocalImport && "Import declaration already in the chain");
1280 assert(!Import->isFromASTFile() && "Non-local import declaration");
1281 if (!FirstLocalImport) {
1282 FirstLocalImport = Import;
1283 LastLocalImport = Import;
1284 return;
1285 }
1286
1287 LastLocalImport->NextLocalImport = Import;
1288 LastLocalImport = Import;
1289}
1290
Chris Lattner53cfe802007-07-18 17:52:12 +00001291//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1292// Type Sizing and Analysis
1293//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001294
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001295/// getFloatTypeSemantics - Return the APFloat 'semantics' for the specified
1296/// scalar floating point type.
1297const llvm::fltSemantics &ASTContext::getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001298 const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001299 assert(BT && "Not a floating point type!");
1300 switch (BT->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001301 default: llvm_unreachable("Not a floating point type!");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001302 case BuiltinType::Half: return Target->getHalfFormat();
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001303 case BuiltinType::Float: return Target->getFloatFormat();
1304 case BuiltinType::Double: return Target->getDoubleFormat();
1305 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return Target->getLongDoubleFormat();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001306 }
1307}
1308
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001309CharUnits ASTContext::getDeclAlign(const Decl *D, bool ForAlignof) const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001310 unsigned Align = Target->getCharWidth();
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001311
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001312 bool UseAlignAttrOnly = false;
1313 if (unsigned AlignFromAttr = D->getMaxAlignment()) {
1314 Align = AlignFromAttr;
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001315
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001316 // __attribute__((aligned)) can increase or decrease alignment
1317 // *except* on a struct or struct member, where it only increases
1318 // alignment unless 'packed' is also specified.
1319 //
Peter Collingbourne2f3cf4b2011-09-29 18:04:28 +00001320 // It is an error for alignas to decrease alignment, so we can
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001321 // ignore that possibility; Sema should diagnose it.
1322 if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) {
1323 UseAlignAttrOnly = D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1324 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1325 } else {
1326 UseAlignAttrOnly = true;
1327 }
1328 }
Fariborz Jahanian9f107182011-05-05 21:19:14 +00001329 else if (isa<FieldDecl>(D))
1330 UseAlignAttrOnly =
1331 D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1332 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001333
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001334 // If we're using the align attribute only, just ignore everything
1335 // else about the declaration and its type.
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001336 if (UseAlignAttrOnly) {
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001337 // do nothing
1338
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001339 } else if (const ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D)) {
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001340 QualType T = VD->getType();
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001341 if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001342 if (ForAlignof)
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001343 T = RT->getPointeeType();
1344 else
1345 T = getPointerType(RT->getPointeeType());
1346 }
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001347 QualType BaseT = getBaseElementType(T);
1348 if (!BaseT->isIncompleteType() && !T->isFunctionType()) {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001349 // Adjust alignments of declarations with array type by the
1350 // large-array alignment on the target.
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001351 if (const ArrayType *arrayType = getAsArrayType(T)) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001352 unsigned MinWidth = Target->getLargeArrayMinWidth();
1353 if (!ForAlignof && MinWidth) {
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001354 if (isa<VariableArrayType>(arrayType))
1355 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1356 else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType) &&
1357 MinWidth <= getTypeSize(cast<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType)))
1358 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1359 }
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001360 }
Chad Rosier99ee7822011-07-26 07:03:04 +00001361 Align = std::max(Align, getPreferredTypeAlign(T.getTypePtr()));
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001362 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Ulrich Weigandb63f7792015-04-21 17:26:18 +00001363 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage() && !ForAlignof)
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001364 Align = std::max(Align, getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1365 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001366 }
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001367
1368 // Fields can be subject to extra alignment constraints, like if
1369 // the field is packed, the struct is packed, or the struct has a
1370 // a max-field-alignment constraint (#pragma pack). So calculate
1371 // the actual alignment of the field within the struct, and then
1372 // (as we're expected to) constrain that by the alignment of the type.
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001373 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
1374 const RecordDecl *Parent = Field->getParent();
1375 // We can only produce a sensible answer if the record is valid.
1376 if (!Parent->isInvalidDecl()) {
1377 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(Parent);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001378
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001379 // Start with the record's overall alignment.
1380 unsigned FieldAlign = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001381
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001382 // Use the GCD of that and the offset within the record.
1383 uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(Field->getFieldIndex());
1384 if (Offset > 0) {
1385 // Alignment is always a power of 2, so the GCD will be a power of 2,
1386 // which means we get to do this crazy thing instead of Euclid's.
1387 uint64_t LowBitOfOffset = Offset & (~Offset + 1);
1388 if (LowBitOfOffset < FieldAlign)
1389 FieldAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(LowBitOfOffset);
1390 }
1391
1392 Align = std::min(Align, FieldAlign);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001393 }
Charles Davis3fc51072010-02-23 04:52:00 +00001394 }
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001395 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001396
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001397 return toCharUnitsFromBits(Align);
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001398}
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001399
John McCallf1249922012-08-21 04:10:00 +00001400// getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars - Return the size of a type, in
1401// chars. If the type is a record, its data size is returned. This is
1402// the size of the memcpy that's performed when assigning this type
1403// using a trivial copy/move assignment operator.
1404std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1405ASTContext::getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1406 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> sizeAndAlign = getTypeInfoInChars(T);
1407
1408 // In C++, objects can sometimes be allocated into the tail padding
1409 // of a base-class subobject. We decide whether that's possible
1410 // during class layout, so here we can just trust the layout results.
1411 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1412 if (const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
1413 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
1414 sizeAndAlign.first = layout.getDataSize();
1415 }
1416 }
1417
1418 return sizeAndAlign;
1419}
1420
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001421/// getConstantArrayInfoInChars - Performing the computation in CharUnits
1422/// instead of in bits prevents overflowing the uint64_t for some large arrays.
1423std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1424static getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext &Context,
1425 const ConstantArrayType *CAT) {
1426 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> EltInfo =
1427 Context.getTypeInfoInChars(CAT->getElementType());
1428 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Trieuc7509072013-05-14 23:41:50 +00001429 assert((Size == 0 || static_cast<uint64_t>(EltInfo.first.getQuantity()) <=
1430 (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001431 "Overflow in array type char size evaluation");
1432 uint64_t Width = EltInfo.first.getQuantity() * Size;
1433 unsigned Align = EltInfo.second.getQuantity();
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001434 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1435 Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1436 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001437 return std::make_pair(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Width),
1438 CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align));
1439}
1440
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001441std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001442ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001443 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T))
1444 return getConstantArrayInfoInChars(*this, CAT);
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001445 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(T);
1446 return std::make_pair(toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Width),
1447 toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Align));
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001448}
1449
1450std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001451ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const {
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001452 return getTypeInfoInChars(T.getTypePtr());
1453}
1454
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001455bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(const Type *T) const {
1456 return getTypeInfo(T).AlignIsRequired;
1457}
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001458
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001459bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(QualType T) const {
1460 return isAlignmentRequired(T.getTypePtr());
1461}
1462
1463TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfo(const Type *T) const {
David Majnemerf8d38642014-07-30 08:42:33 +00001464 TypeInfoMap::iterator I = MemoizedTypeInfo.find(T);
1465 if (I != MemoizedTypeInfo.end())
1466 return I->second;
1467
1468 // This call can invalidate MemoizedTypeInfo[T], so we need a second lookup.
1469 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfoImpl(T);
1470 MemoizedTypeInfo[T] = TI;
Rafael Espindolaeaa88c12014-07-30 04:40:23 +00001471 return TI;
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001472}
1473
1474/// getTypeInfoImpl - Return the size of the specified type, in bits. This
1475/// method does not work on incomplete types.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001476///
1477/// FIXME: Pointers into different addr spaces could have different sizes and
1478/// alignment requirements: getPointerInfo should take an AddrSpace, this
1479/// should take a QualType, &c.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001480TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfoImpl(const Type *T) const {
1481 uint64_t Width = 0;
1482 unsigned Align = 8;
1483 bool AlignIsRequired = false;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001484 switch (T->getTypeClass()) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001485#define TYPE(Class, Base)
1486#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001487#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001488#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
David Blaikieab277d62013-07-13 21:08:03 +00001489#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) \
1490 case Type::Class: \
1491 assert(!T->isDependentType() && "should not see dependent types here"); \
1492 return getTypeInfo(cast<Class##Type>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001493#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
John McCall15547bb2011-06-28 16:49:23 +00001494 llvm_unreachable("Should not see dependent types");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001495
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001496 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
1497 case Type::FunctionProto:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001498 // GCC extension: alignof(function) = 32 bits
1499 Width = 0;
1500 Align = 32;
1501 break;
1502
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001503 case Type::IncompleteArray:
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001504 case Type::VariableArray:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001505 Width = 0;
1506 Align = getTypeAlign(cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType());
1507 break;
1508
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001509 case Type::ConstantArray: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001510 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = cast<ConstantArrayType>(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001511
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001512 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(CAT->getElementType());
Abramo Bagnarad541a4c2011-12-13 11:23:52 +00001513 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001514 assert((Size == 0 || EltInfo.Width <= (uint64_t)(-1) / Size) &&
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001515 "Overflow in array type bit size evaluation");
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001516 Width = EltInfo.Width * Size;
1517 Align = EltInfo.Align;
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001518 if (!getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1519 getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1520 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001521 break;
Christopher Lambc5fafa22007-12-29 05:10:55 +00001522 }
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00001523 case Type::ExtVector:
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001524 case Type::Vector: {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001525 const VectorType *VT = cast<VectorType>(T);
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001526 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(VT->getElementType());
1527 Width = EltInfo.Width * VT->getNumElements();
Eli Friedman3df5efe2008-05-30 09:31:38 +00001528 Align = Width;
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +00001529 // If the alignment is not a power of 2, round up to the next power of 2.
1530 // This happens for non-power-of-2 length vectors.
Dan Gohmanef78c8e2010-04-21 23:32:43 +00001531 if (Align & (Align-1)) {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001532 Align = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Align);
1533 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
1534 }
Chad Rosiercc40ea72012-07-13 23:57:43 +00001535 // Adjust the alignment based on the target max.
1536 uint64_t TargetVectorAlign = Target->getMaxVectorAlign();
1537 if (TargetVectorAlign && TargetVectorAlign < Align)
1538 Align = TargetVectorAlign;
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001539 break;
1540 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001541
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001542 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001543 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001544 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type!");
Chris Lattner4481b422007-07-14 01:29:45 +00001545 case BuiltinType::Void:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001546 // GCC extension: alignof(void) = 8 bits.
1547 Width = 0;
1548 Align = 8;
1549 break;
1550
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001551 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001552 Width = Target->getBoolWidth();
1553 Align = Target->getBoolAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001554 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001555 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
1556 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
1557 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001558 case BuiltinType::SChar:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001559 Width = Target->getCharWidth();
1560 Align = Target->getCharAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001561 break;
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00001562 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
1563 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001564 Width = Target->getWCharWidth();
1565 Align = Target->getWCharAlign();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001566 break;
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001567 case BuiltinType::Char16:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001568 Width = Target->getChar16Width();
1569 Align = Target->getChar16Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001570 break;
1571 case BuiltinType::Char32:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001572 Width = Target->getChar32Width();
1573 Align = Target->getChar32Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001574 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001575 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001576 case BuiltinType::Short:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001577 Width = Target->getShortWidth();
1578 Align = Target->getShortAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001579 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001580 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001581 case BuiltinType::Int:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001582 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1583 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001584 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001585 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001586 case BuiltinType::Long:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001587 Width = Target->getLongWidth();
1588 Align = Target->getLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001589 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001590 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001591 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001592 Width = Target->getLongLongWidth();
1593 Align = Target->getLongLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001594 break;
Chris Lattner0a415ec2009-04-30 02:55:13 +00001595 case BuiltinType::Int128:
1596 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
1597 Width = 128;
1598 Align = 128; // int128_t is 128-bit aligned on all targets.
1599 break;
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001600 case BuiltinType::Half:
1601 Width = Target->getHalfWidth();
1602 Align = Target->getHalfAlign();
1603 break;
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001604 case BuiltinType::Float:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001605 Width = Target->getFloatWidth();
1606 Align = Target->getFloatAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001607 break;
1608 case BuiltinType::Double:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001609 Width = Target->getDoubleWidth();
1610 Align = Target->getDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001611 break;
1612 case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001613 Width = Target->getLongDoubleWidth();
1614 Align = Target->getLongDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001615 break;
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001616 case BuiltinType::NullPtr:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001617 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); // C++ 3.9.1p11: sizeof(nullptr_t)
1618 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); // == sizeof(void*)
Sebastian Redla81b0b72009-05-27 19:34:06 +00001619 break;
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001620 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
1621 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
1622 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001623 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1624 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001625 break;
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001626 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
1627 // Samplers are modeled as integers.
1628 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1629 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
1630 break;
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001631 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001632 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
1633 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
1634 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
1635 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
1636 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
1637 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
1638 // Currently these types are pointers to opaque types.
1639 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1640 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
1641 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001642 }
Chris Lattner48f84b82007-07-15 23:46:53 +00001643 break;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00001644 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001645 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1646 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001647 break;
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001648 case Type::BlockPointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001649 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1650 cast<BlockPointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001651 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1652 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001653 break;
1654 }
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001655 case Type::LValueReference:
1656 case Type::RValueReference: {
1657 // alignof and sizeof should never enter this code path here, so we go
1658 // the pointer route.
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001659 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1660 cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001661 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1662 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001663 break;
1664 }
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001665 case Type::Pointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001666 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<PointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001667 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1668 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001669 break;
1670 }
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001671 case Type::MemberPointer: {
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00001672 const MemberPointerType *MPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(T);
Benjamin Kramer867ea1d2014-03-02 13:01:17 +00001673 std::tie(Width, Align) = ABI->getMemberPointerWidthAndAlign(MPT);
Anders Carlsson32440a02009-05-17 02:06:04 +00001674 break;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001675 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001676 case Type::Complex: {
1677 // Complex types have the same alignment as their elements, but twice the
1678 // size.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001679 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType());
1680 Width = EltInfo.Width * 2;
1681 Align = EltInfo.Align;
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001682 break;
1683 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001684 case Type::ObjCObject:
1685 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCObjectType>(T)->getBaseType().getTypePtr());
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001686 case Type::Adjusted:
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00001687 case Type::Decayed:
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001688 return getTypeInfo(cast<AdjustedType>(T)->getAdjustedType().getTypePtr());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001689 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001690 const ObjCInterfaceType *ObjCI = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(T);
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001691 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl());
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001692 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001693 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001694 break;
1695 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001696 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001697 case Type::Enum: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001698 const TagType *TT = cast<TagType>(T);
1699
1700 if (TT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
Douglas Gregor7f971892011-04-20 17:29:44 +00001701 Width = 8;
1702 Align = 8;
Chris Lattner572100b2008-08-09 21:35:13 +00001703 break;
1704 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001705
David Majnemer475b25e2015-01-21 10:54:38 +00001706 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(TT)) {
1707 const EnumDecl *ED = ET->getDecl();
1708 TypeInfo Info =
1709 getTypeInfo(ED->getIntegerType()->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
1710 if (unsigned AttrAlign = ED->getMaxAlignment()) {
1711 Info.Align = AttrAlign;
1712 Info.AlignIsRequired = true;
1713 }
1714 return Info;
1715 }
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001716
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001717 const RecordType *RT = cast<RecordType>(TT);
David Majnemer5821ff72015-02-03 08:49:29 +00001718 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
1719 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RD);
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001720 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001721 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
David Majnemer5821ff72015-02-03 08:49:29 +00001722 AlignIsRequired = RD->hasAttr<AlignedAttr>();
Chris Lattner49a953a2007-07-23 22:46:22 +00001723 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001724 }
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001725
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001726 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001727 return getTypeInfo(cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(T)->
1728 getReplacementType().getTypePtr());
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001729
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001730 case Type::Auto: {
1731 const AutoType *A = cast<AutoType>(T);
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00001732 assert(!A->getDeducedType().isNull() &&
1733 "cannot request the size of an undeduced or dependent auto type");
Matt Beaumont-Gay7a24210e2011-02-22 20:00:16 +00001734 return getTypeInfo(A->getDeducedType().getTypePtr());
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001735 }
1736
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00001737 case Type::Paren:
1738 return getTypeInfo(cast<ParenType>(T)->getInnerType().getTypePtr());
1739
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001740 case Type::Typedef: {
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00001741 const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = cast<TypedefType>(T)->getDecl();
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001742 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(Typedef->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr());
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001743 // If the typedef has an aligned attribute on it, it overrides any computed
1744 // alignment we have. This violates the GCC documentation (which says that
1745 // attribute(aligned) can only round up) but matches its implementation.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001746 if (unsigned AttrAlign = Typedef->getMaxAlignment()) {
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001747 Align = AttrAlign;
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001748 AlignIsRequired = true;
David Majnemer37bffb62014-08-04 05:11:01 +00001749 } else {
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001750 Align = Info.Align;
David Majnemer37bffb62014-08-04 05:11:01 +00001751 AlignIsRequired = Info.AlignIsRequired;
1752 }
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001753 Width = Info.Width;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001754 break;
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001755 }
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001756
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00001757 case Type::Elaborated:
1758 return getTypeInfo(cast<ElaboratedType>(T)->getNamedType().getTypePtr());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001759
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00001760 case Type::Attributed:
1761 return getTypeInfo(
1762 cast<AttributedType>(T)->getEquivalentType().getTypePtr());
1763
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001764 case Type::Atomic: {
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001765 // Start with the base type information.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001766 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType());
1767 Width = Info.Width;
1768 Align = Info.Align;
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001769
1770 // If the size of the type doesn't exceed the platform's max
1771 // atomic promotion width, make the size and alignment more
1772 // favorable to atomic operations:
1773 if (Width != 0 && Width <= Target->getMaxAtomicPromoteWidth()) {
1774 // Round the size up to a power of 2.
1775 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width))
1776 Width = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Width);
1777
1778 // Set the alignment equal to the size.
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001779 Align = static_cast<unsigned>(Width);
1780 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001781 }
1782
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001783 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001784
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001785 assert(llvm::isPowerOf2_32(Align) && "Alignment must be power of 2");
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001786 return TypeInfo(Width, Align, AlignIsRequired);
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001787}
1788
Alexey Bataev00396512015-07-02 03:40:19 +00001789unsigned ASTContext::getOpenMPDefaultSimdAlign(QualType T) const {
1790 unsigned SimdAlign = getTargetInfo().getSimdDefaultAlign();
1791 // Target ppc64 with QPX: simd default alignment for pointer to double is 32.
1792 if ((getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64 ||
1793 getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64le) &&
1794 getTargetInfo().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx" &&
1795 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double))
1796 SimdAlign = 256;
1797 return SimdAlign;
1798}
1799
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001800/// toCharUnitsFromBits - Convert a size in bits to a size in characters.
1801CharUnits ASTContext::toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const {
1802 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(BitSize / getCharWidth());
1803}
1804
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001805/// toBits - Convert a size in characters to a size in characters.
1806int64_t ASTContext::toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const {
1807 return CharSize.getQuantity() * getCharWidth();
1808}
1809
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001810/// getTypeSizeInChars - Return the size of the specified type, in characters.
1811/// This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001812CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001813 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001814}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001815CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001816 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001817}
1818
Ken Dycka6046ab2010-01-26 17:25:18 +00001819/// getTypeAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a type, in
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001820/// characters. This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001821CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001822 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001823}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001824CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(const Type *T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001825 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001826}
1827
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001828/// getPreferredTypeAlign - Return the "preferred" alignment of the specified
1829/// type for the current target in bits. This can be different than the ABI
1830/// alignment in cases where it is beneficial for performance to overalign
1831/// a data type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001832unsigned ASTContext::getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type *T) const {
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001833 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfo(T);
1834 unsigned ABIAlign = TI.Align;
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001835
David Majnemere1544562015-04-24 01:25:05 +00001836 T = T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
1837
1838 // The preferred alignment of member pointers is that of a pointer.
1839 if (T->isMemberPointerType())
1840 return getPreferredTypeAlign(getPointerDiffType().getTypePtr());
1841
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +00001842 if (Target->getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::xcore)
1843 return ABIAlign; // Never overalign on XCore.
1844
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001845 // Double and long long should be naturally aligned if possible.
David Majnemer1d4db8f2014-02-24 23:43:27 +00001846 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001847 T = CT->getElementType().getTypePtr();
David Majnemer475b25e2015-01-21 10:54:38 +00001848 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
1849 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001850 if (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double) ||
Chad Rosierb57321a2012-03-21 20:20:47 +00001851 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) ||
1852 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong))
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00001853 // Don't increase the alignment if an alignment attribute was specified on a
1854 // typedef declaration.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001855 if (!TI.AlignIsRequired)
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00001856 return std::max(ABIAlign, (unsigned)getTypeSize(T));
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001857
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001858 return ABIAlign;
1859}
1860
Ulrich Weigandca3cb7f2015-04-21 17:29:35 +00001861/// getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned - Return the default alignment
1862/// for __attribute__((aligned)) on this target, to be used if no alignment
1863/// value is specified.
1864unsigned ASTContext::getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned(void) const {
1865 return getTargetInfo().getDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned();
1866}
1867
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001868/// getAlignOfGlobalVar - Return the alignment in bits that should be given
1869/// to a global variable of the specified type.
1870unsigned ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T) const {
1871 return std::max(getTypeAlign(T), getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1872}
1873
1874/// getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars - Return the alignment in characters that
1875/// should be given to a global variable of the specified type.
1876CharUnits ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T) const {
1877 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getAlignOfGlobalVar(T));
1878}
1879
David Majnemer08ef2ba2015-06-23 20:34:18 +00001880CharUnits ASTContext::getOffsetOfBaseWithVBPtr(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
1881 CharUnits Offset = CharUnits::Zero();
1882 const ASTRecordLayout *Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(RD);
1883 while (const CXXRecordDecl *Base = Layout->getBaseSharingVBPtr()) {
1884 Offset += Layout->getBaseClassOffset(Base);
1885 Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(Base);
1886 }
1887 return Offset;
1888}
1889
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001890/// DeepCollectObjCIvars -
1891/// This routine first collects all declared, but not synthesized, ivars in
1892/// super class and then collects all ivars, including those synthesized for
1893/// current class. This routine is used for implementation of current class
1894/// when all ivars, declared and synthesized are known.
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001895///
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001896void ASTContext::DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI,
1897 bool leafClass,
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001898 SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl*> &Ivars) const {
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001899 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *SuperClass = OI->getSuperClass())
1900 DeepCollectObjCIvars(SuperClass, false, Ivars);
1901 if (!leafClass) {
Aaron Ballman59abbd42014-03-13 21:09:43 +00001902 for (const auto *I : OI->ivars())
1903 Ivars.push_back(I);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00001904 } else {
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001905 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(OI);
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001906 for (const ObjCIvarDecl *Iv = IDecl->all_declared_ivar_begin(); Iv;
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001907 Iv= Iv->getNextIvar())
1908 Ivars.push_back(Iv);
1909 }
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001910}
1911
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001912/// CollectInheritedProtocols - Collect all protocols in current class and
1913/// those inherited by it.
1914void ASTContext::CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl *CDecl,
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00001915 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> &Protocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001916 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CDecl)) {
Ted Kremenek0ef508d2010-09-01 01:21:15 +00001917 // We can use protocol_iterator here instead of
1918 // all_referenced_protocol_iterator since we are walking all categories.
Aaron Ballmana9f49e32014-03-13 20:55:22 +00001919 for (auto *Proto : OI->all_referenced_protocols()) {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001920 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00001921 for (auto *P : Proto->protocols()) {
1922 Protocols.insert(P->getCanonicalDecl());
1923 CollectInheritedProtocols(P, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001924 }
Fariborz Jahanian8e3b9db2010-02-25 18:24:33 +00001925 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001926
1927 // Categories of this Interface.
Aaron Ballman3fe486a2014-03-13 21:23:55 +00001928 for (const auto *Cat : OI->visible_categories())
1929 CollectInheritedProtocols(Cat, Protocols);
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001930
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001931 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *SD = OI->getSuperClass())
1932 while (SD) {
1933 CollectInheritedProtocols(SD, Protocols);
1934 SD = SD->getSuperClass();
1935 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001936 } else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *OC = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CDecl)) {
Aaron Ballman19a41762014-03-14 12:55:57 +00001937 for (auto *Proto : OC->protocols()) {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001938 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00001939 for (const auto *P : Proto->protocols())
1940 CollectInheritedProtocols(P, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001941 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001942 } else if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *OP = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(CDecl)) {
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00001943 for (auto *Proto : OP->protocols()) {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001944 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00001945 for (const auto *P : Proto->protocols())
1946 CollectInheritedProtocols(P, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001947 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001948 }
1949}
1950
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001951unsigned ASTContext::CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI) const {
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00001952 unsigned count = 0;
1953 // Count ivars declared in class extension.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +00001954 for (const auto *Ext : OI->known_extensions())
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001955 count += Ext->ivar_size();
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001956
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00001957 // Count ivar defined in this class's implementation. This
1958 // includes synthesized ivars.
1959 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplDecl = OI->getImplementation())
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001960 count += ImplDecl->ivar_size();
1961
Fariborz Jahanian7c809592009-06-04 01:19:09 +00001962 return count;
1963}
1964
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2e809ce2012-02-03 05:58:16 +00001965bool ASTContext::isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr *E) {
1966 if (!E)
1967 return false;
1968
1969 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
1970 if (E->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return true;
1971
1972 if (E->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
1973 E->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(*this,
1974 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
1975 return true;
1976
1977 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
1978 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(E)) return true;
1979
1980 return false;
1981}
1982
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00001983/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl,or NULL if none exists.
1984ObjCImplementationDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) {
1985 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
1986 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
1987 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
1988 return cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001989 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00001990}
1991/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl, or NULL if none exists.
1992ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *D) {
1993 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
1994 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
1995 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
1996 return cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001997 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00001998}
1999
2000/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl.
2001void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFaceD,
2002 ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplD) {
2003 assert(IFaceD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2004 ObjCImpls[IFaceD] = ImplD;
2005}
2006/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl.
2007void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD,
2008 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ImplD) {
2009 assert(CatD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2010 ObjCImpls[CatD] = ImplD;
2011}
2012
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002013const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjContainingInterface(
2014 const NamedDecl *ND) const {
2015 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID =
2016 dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002017 return ID;
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002018 if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD =
2019 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002020 return CD->getClassInterface();
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002021 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD =
2022 dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002023 return IMD->getClassInterface();
2024
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002025 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002026}
2027
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002028/// \brief Get the copy initialization expression of VarDecl,or NULL if
2029/// none exists.
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00002030Expr *ASTContext::getBlockVarCopyInits(const VarDecl*VD) {
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002031 assert(VD && "Passed null params");
2032 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2033 "getBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00002034 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl*, Expr*>::iterator
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002035 I = BlockVarCopyInits.find(VD);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002036 return (I != BlockVarCopyInits.end()) ? cast<Expr>(I->second) : nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002037}
2038
2039/// \brief Set the copy inialization expression of a block var decl.
2040void ASTContext::setBlockVarCopyInits(VarDecl*VD, Expr* Init) {
2041 assert(VD && Init && "Passed null params");
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002042 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2043 "setBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002044 BlockVarCopyInits[VD] = Init;
2045}
2046
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002047TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002048 unsigned DataSize) const {
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00002049 if (!DataSize)
2050 DataSize = TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T);
2051 else
2052 assert(DataSize == TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T) &&
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002053 "incorrect data size provided to CreateTypeSourceInfo!");
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00002054
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002055 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo =
2056 (TypeSourceInfo*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(TypeSourceInfo) + DataSize, 8);
2057 new (TInfo) TypeSourceInfo(T);
2058 return TInfo;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis3f79ad72009-08-19 01:27:32 +00002059}
2060
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002061TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +00002062 SourceLocation L) const {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002063 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(T);
Douglas Gregor2d525f02011-01-25 19:13:18 +00002064 DI->getTypeLoc().initialize(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), L);
John McCall3665e002009-10-23 21:14:09 +00002065 return DI;
2066}
2067
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002068const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002069ASTContext::getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) const {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002070 return getObjCLayout(D, nullptr);
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002071}
2072
2073const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002074ASTContext::getASTObjCImplementationLayout(
2075 const ObjCImplementationDecl *D) const {
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002076 return getObjCLayout(D->getClassInterface(), D);
2077}
2078
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002079//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2080// Type creation/memoization methods
2081//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2082
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002083QualType
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002084ASTContext::getExtQualType(const Type *baseType, Qualifiers quals) const {
2085 unsigned fastQuals = quals.getFastQualifiers();
2086 quals.removeFastQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002087
2088 // Check if we've already instantiated this type.
2089 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002090 ExtQuals::Profile(ID, baseType, quals);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002091 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002092 if (ExtQuals *eq = ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) {
2093 assert(eq->getQualifiers() == quals);
2094 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002095 }
2096
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002097 // If the base type is not canonical, make the appropriate canonical type.
2098 QualType canon;
2099 if (!baseType->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
2100 SplitQualType canonSplit = baseType->getCanonicalTypeInternal().split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002101 canonSplit.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(quals);
2102 canon = getExtQualType(canonSplit.Ty, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002103
2104 // Re-find the insert position.
2105 (void) ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2106 }
2107
2108 ExtQuals *eq = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ExtQuals(baseType, canon, quals);
2109 ExtQualNodes.InsertNode(eq, insertPos);
2110 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002111}
2112
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002113QualType
2114ASTContext::getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T, unsigned AddressSpace) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002115 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
2116 if (CanT.getAddressSpace() == AddressSpace)
Chris Lattner445fcab2008-02-20 20:55:12 +00002117 return T;
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002118
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002119 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2120 // into one ExtQuals node.
2121 QualifierCollector Quals;
2122 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002123
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002124 // If this type already has an address space specified, it cannot get
2125 // another one.
2126 assert(!Quals.hasAddressSpace() &&
2127 "Type cannot be in multiple addr spaces!");
2128 Quals.addAddressSpace(AddressSpace);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002129
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002130 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Christopher Lamb025b5fb2008-02-04 02:31:56 +00002131}
2132
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002133QualType ASTContext::getObjCGCQualType(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002134 Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const {
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002135 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002136 if (CanT.getObjCGCAttr() == GCAttr)
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002137 return T;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002138
John McCall53fa7142010-12-24 02:08:15 +00002139 if (const PointerType *ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2140 QualType Pointee = ptr->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00002141 if (Pointee->isAnyPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb68215c2009-06-03 17:15:17 +00002142 QualType ResultType = getObjCGCQualType(Pointee, GCAttr);
2143 return getPointerType(ResultType);
2144 }
2145 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002146
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002147 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2148 // into one ExtQuals node.
2149 QualifierCollector Quals;
2150 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002151
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002152 // If this type already has an ObjCGC specified, it cannot get
2153 // another one.
2154 assert(!Quals.hasObjCGCAttr() &&
2155 "Type cannot have multiple ObjCGCs!");
2156 Quals.addObjCGCAttr(GCAttr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002157
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002158 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002159}
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002160
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002161const FunctionType *ASTContext::adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType *T,
2162 FunctionType::ExtInfo Info) {
2163 if (T->getExtInfo() == Info)
2164 return T;
2165
2166 QualType Result;
2167 if (const FunctionNoProtoType *FNPT = dyn_cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(T)) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002168 Result = getFunctionNoProtoType(FNPT->getReturnType(), Info);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002169 } else {
2170 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(T);
2171 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2172 EPI.ExtInfo = Info;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002173 Result = getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002174 }
2175
2176 return cast<FunctionType>(Result.getTypePtr());
2177}
2178
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002179void ASTContext::adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl *FD,
2180 QualType ResultType) {
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002181 FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl();
2182 while (true) {
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002183 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2184 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002185 FD->setType(getFunctionType(ResultType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI));
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002186 if (FunctionDecl *Next = FD->getPreviousDecl())
2187 FD = Next;
2188 else
2189 break;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002190 }
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002191 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener())
2192 L->DeducedReturnType(FD, ResultType);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002193}
2194
Richard Smith0b3a4622014-11-13 20:01:57 +00002195/// Get a function type and produce the equivalent function type with the
2196/// specified exception specification. Type sugar that can be present on a
2197/// declaration of a function with an exception specification is permitted
2198/// and preserved. Other type sugar (for instance, typedefs) is not.
2199static QualType getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(
2200 ASTContext &Context, QualType Orig,
2201 const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI) {
2202 // Might have some parens.
2203 if (auto *PT = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Orig))
2204 return Context.getParenType(
2205 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, PT->getInnerType(), ESI));
2206
2207 // Might have a calling-convention attribute.
2208 if (auto *AT = dyn_cast<AttributedType>(Orig))
2209 return Context.getAttributedType(
2210 AT->getAttrKind(),
2211 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getModifiedType(), ESI),
2212 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getEquivalentType(),
2213 ESI));
2214
2215 // Anything else must be a function type. Rebuild it with the new exception
2216 // specification.
2217 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Orig);
2218 return Context.getFunctionType(
2219 Proto->getReturnType(), Proto->getParamTypes(),
2220 Proto->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(ESI));
2221}
2222
2223void ASTContext::adjustExceptionSpec(
2224 FunctionDecl *FD, const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI,
2225 bool AsWritten) {
2226 // Update the type.
2227 QualType Updated =
2228 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, FD->getType(), ESI);
2229 FD->setType(Updated);
2230
2231 if (!AsWritten)
2232 return;
2233
2234 // Update the type in the type source information too.
2235 if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()) {
2236 // If the type and the type-as-written differ, we may need to update
2237 // the type-as-written too.
2238 if (TSInfo->getType() != FD->getType())
2239 Updated = getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, TSInfo->getType(), ESI);
2240
2241 // FIXME: When we get proper type location information for exceptions,
2242 // we'll also have to rebuild the TypeSourceInfo. For now, we just patch
2243 // up the TypeSourceInfo;
2244 assert(TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(Updated) ==
2245 TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(TSInfo->getType()) &&
2246 "TypeLoc size mismatch from updating exception specification");
2247 TSInfo->overrideType(Updated);
2248 }
2249}
2250
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002251/// getComplexType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a complex
2252/// number with the specified element type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002253QualType ASTContext::getComplexType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002254 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2255 // structure.
2256 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2257 ComplexType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002258
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002259 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002260 if (ComplexType *CT = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2261 return QualType(CT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002262
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002263 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2264 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2265 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002266 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002267 Canonical = getComplexType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002268
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002269 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2270 ComplexType *NewIP = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002271 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002272 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002273 ComplexType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ComplexType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002274 Types.push_back(New);
2275 ComplexTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2276 return QualType(New, 0);
2277}
2278
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00002279/// getPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a pointer to
2280/// the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002281QualType ASTContext::getPointerType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +00002282 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2283 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002284 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002285 PointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002286
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002287 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002288 if (PointerType *PT = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002289 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002290
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002291 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2292 // so fill in the canonical type field.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002293 QualType Canonical;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002294 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002295 Canonical = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002296
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002297 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2298 PointerType *NewIP = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002299 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002300 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002301 PointerType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PointerType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002302 Types.push_back(New);
2303 PointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002304 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00002305}
2306
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002307QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedType(QualType Orig, QualType New) const {
2308 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2309 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, Orig, New);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002310 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002311 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2312 if (AT)
2313 return QualType(AT, 0);
2314
2315 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(New);
2316
2317 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2318 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002319 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002320
2321 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2322 AdjustedType(Type::Adjusted, Orig, New, Canonical);
2323 Types.push_back(AT);
2324 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2325 return QualType(AT, 0);
2326}
2327
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002328QualType ASTContext::getDecayedType(QualType T) const {
2329 assert((T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) && "T does not decay");
2330
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002331 QualType Decayed;
2332
2333 // C99 6.7.5.3p7:
2334 // A declaration of a parameter as "array of type" shall be
2335 // adjusted to "qualified pointer to type", where the type
2336 // qualifiers (if any) are those specified within the [ and ] of
2337 // the array type derivation.
2338 if (T->isArrayType())
2339 Decayed = getArrayDecayedType(T);
2340
2341 // C99 6.7.5.3p8:
2342 // A declaration of a parameter as "function returning type"
2343 // shall be adjusted to "pointer to function returning type", as
2344 // in 6.3.2.1.
2345 if (T->isFunctionType())
2346 Decayed = getPointerType(T);
2347
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002348 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2349 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, T, Decayed);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002350 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002351 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2352 if (AT)
2353 return QualType(AT, 0);
2354
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002355 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decayed);
2356
2357 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002358 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002359 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002360
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002361 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecayedType(T, Decayed, Canonical);
2362 Types.push_back(AT);
2363 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2364 return QualType(AT, 0);
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002365}
2366
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002367/// getBlockPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002368/// a pointer to the specified block.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002369QualType ASTContext::getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const {
Steve Naroff0ac012832008-08-28 19:20:44 +00002370 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "block of function types only");
2371 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one block of a particular
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002372 // structure.
2373 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2374 BlockPointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002375
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002376 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002377 if (BlockPointerType *PT =
2378 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2379 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002380
2381 // If the block pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002382 // type either so fill in the canonical type field.
2383 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002384 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002385 Canonical = getBlockPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002386
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002387 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2388 BlockPointerType *NewIP =
2389 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002390 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002391 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002392 BlockPointerType *New
2393 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BlockPointerType(T, Canonical);
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002394 Types.push_back(New);
2395 BlockPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2396 return QualType(New, 0);
2397}
2398
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002399/// getLValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2400/// lvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002401QualType
2402ASTContext::getLValueReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue) const {
Douglas Gregor291e8ee2011-05-21 22:16:50 +00002403 assert(getCanonicalType(T) != OverloadTy &&
2404 "Unresolved overloaded function type");
2405
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002406 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2407 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002408 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002409 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002410
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002411 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002412 if (LValueReferenceType *RT =
2413 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002414 return QualType(RT, 0);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002415
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002416 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2417
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002418 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2419 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2420 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002421 if (!SpelledAsLValue || InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2422 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2423 Canonical = getLValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002424
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002425 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002426 LValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2427 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002428 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002429 }
2430
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002431 LValueReferenceType *New
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002432 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) LValueReferenceType(T, Canonical,
2433 SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002434 Types.push_back(New);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002435 LValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002436
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002437 return QualType(New, 0);
2438}
2439
2440/// getRValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2441/// rvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002442QualType ASTContext::getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const {
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002443 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2444 // structure.
2445 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002446 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, false);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002447
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002448 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002449 if (RValueReferenceType *RT =
2450 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2451 return QualType(RT, 0);
2452
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002453 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2454
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002455 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2456 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2457 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002458 if (InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2459 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2460 Canonical = getRValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002461
2462 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2463 RValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2464 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002465 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002466 }
2467
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002468 RValueReferenceType *New
2469 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RValueReferenceType(T, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002470 Types.push_back(New);
2471 RValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002472 return QualType(New, 0);
2473}
2474
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002475/// getMemberPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a
2476/// member pointer to the specified type, in the specified class.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002477QualType ASTContext::getMemberPointerType(QualType T, const Type *Cls) const {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002478 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2479 // structure.
2480 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2481 MemberPointerType::Profile(ID, T, Cls);
2482
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002483 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002484 if (MemberPointerType *PT =
2485 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2486 return QualType(PT, 0);
2487
2488 // If the pointee or class type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
2489 // type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2490 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor615ac672009-11-04 16:49:01 +00002491 if (!T.isCanonical() || !Cls->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002492 Canonical = getMemberPointerType(getCanonicalType(T),getCanonicalType(Cls));
2493
2494 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2495 MemberPointerType *NewIP =
2496 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002497 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002498 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002499 MemberPointerType *New
2500 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) MemberPointerType(T, Cls, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002501 Types.push_back(New);
2502 MemberPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2503 return QualType(New, 0);
2504}
2505
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002506/// getConstantArrayType - Return the unique reference to the type for an
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002507/// array of the specified element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002508QualType ASTContext::getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy,
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002509 const llvm::APInt &ArySizeIn,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002510 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002511 unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const {
Sebastian Redl2dfdb822009-11-05 15:52:31 +00002512 assert((EltTy->isDependentType() ||
2513 EltTy->isIncompleteType() || EltTy->isConstantSizeType()) &&
Eli Friedmanbe7e42b2009-05-29 20:17:55 +00002514 "Constant array of VLAs is illegal!");
2515
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002516 // Convert the array size into a canonical width matching the pointer size for
2517 // the target.
2518 llvm::APInt ArySize(ArySizeIn);
Jay Foad6d4db0c2010-12-07 08:25:34 +00002519 ArySize =
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00002520 ArySize.zextOrTrunc(Target->getPointerWidth(getTargetAddressSpace(EltTy)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002521
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002522 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002523 ConstantArrayType::Profile(ID, EltTy, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002524
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002525 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002526 if (ConstantArrayType *ATP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002527 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002528 return QualType(ATP, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002529
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002530 // If the element type isn't canonical or has qualifiers, this won't
2531 // be a canonical type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2532 QualType Canon;
2533 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2534 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002535 Canon = getConstantArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), ArySize,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002536 ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002537 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002538
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002539 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002540 ConstantArrayType *NewIP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002541 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002542 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002543 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002544
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002545 ConstantArrayType *New = new(*this,TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002546 ConstantArrayType(EltTy, Canon, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002547 ConstantArrayTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002548 Types.push_back(New);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002549 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002550}
2551
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002552/// getVariableArrayDecayedType - Turns the given type, which may be
2553/// variably-modified, into the corresponding type with all the known
2554/// sizes replaced with [*].
2555QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const {
2556 // Vastly most common case.
2557 if (!type->isVariablyModifiedType()) return type;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002558
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002559 QualType result;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002560
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002561 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002562 const Type *ty = split.Ty;
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002563 switch (ty->getTypeClass()) {
2564#define TYPE(Class, Base)
2565#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
2566#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
2567#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
2568 llvm_unreachable("didn't desugar past all non-canonical types?");
2569
2570 // These types should never be variably-modified.
2571 case Type::Builtin:
2572 case Type::Complex:
2573 case Type::Vector:
2574 case Type::ExtVector:
2575 case Type::DependentSizedExtVector:
2576 case Type::ObjCObject:
2577 case Type::ObjCInterface:
2578 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
2579 case Type::Record:
2580 case Type::Enum:
2581 case Type::UnresolvedUsing:
2582 case Type::TypeOfExpr:
2583 case Type::TypeOf:
2584 case Type::Decltype:
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00002585 case Type::UnaryTransform:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002586 case Type::DependentName:
2587 case Type::InjectedClassName:
2588 case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
2589 case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization:
2590 case Type::TemplateTypeParm:
2591 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParmPack:
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00002592 case Type::Auto:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002593 case Type::PackExpansion:
2594 llvm_unreachable("type should never be variably-modified");
2595
2596 // These types can be variably-modified but should never need to
2597 // further decay.
2598 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
2599 case Type::FunctionProto:
2600 case Type::BlockPointer:
2601 case Type::MemberPointer:
2602 return type;
2603
2604 // These types can be variably-modified. All these modifications
2605 // preserve structure except as noted by comments.
2606 // TODO: if we ever care about optimizing VLAs, there are no-op
2607 // optimizations available here.
2608 case Type::Pointer:
2609 result = getPointerType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(
2610 cast<PointerType>(ty)->getPointeeType()));
2611 break;
2612
2613 case Type::LValueReference: {
2614 const LValueReferenceType *lv = cast<LValueReferenceType>(ty);
2615 result = getLValueReferenceType(
2616 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()),
2617 lv->isSpelledAsLValue());
2618 break;
2619 }
2620
2621 case Type::RValueReference: {
2622 const RValueReferenceType *lv = cast<RValueReferenceType>(ty);
2623 result = getRValueReferenceType(
2624 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()));
2625 break;
2626 }
2627
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00002628 case Type::Atomic: {
2629 const AtomicType *at = cast<AtomicType>(ty);
2630 result = getAtomicType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(at->getValueType()));
2631 break;
2632 }
2633
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002634 case Type::ConstantArray: {
2635 const ConstantArrayType *cat = cast<ConstantArrayType>(ty);
2636 result = getConstantArrayType(
2637 getVariableArrayDecayedType(cat->getElementType()),
2638 cat->getSize(),
2639 cat->getSizeModifier(),
2640 cat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers());
2641 break;
2642 }
2643
2644 case Type::DependentSizedArray: {
2645 const DependentSizedArrayType *dat = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ty);
2646 result = getDependentSizedArrayType(
2647 getVariableArrayDecayedType(dat->getElementType()),
2648 dat->getSizeExpr(),
2649 dat->getSizeModifier(),
2650 dat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2651 dat->getBracketsRange());
2652 break;
2653 }
2654
2655 // Turn incomplete types into [*] types.
2656 case Type::IncompleteArray: {
2657 const IncompleteArrayType *iat = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ty);
2658 result = getVariableArrayType(
2659 getVariableArrayDecayedType(iat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002660 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002661 ArrayType::Normal,
2662 iat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2663 SourceRange());
2664 break;
2665 }
2666
2667 // Turn VLA types into [*] types.
2668 case Type::VariableArray: {
2669 const VariableArrayType *vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(ty);
2670 result = getVariableArrayType(
2671 getVariableArrayDecayedType(vat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002672 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002673 ArrayType::Star,
2674 vat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2675 vat->getBracketsRange());
2676 break;
2677 }
2678 }
2679
2680 // Apply the top-level qualifiers from the original.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002681 return getQualifiedType(result, split.Quals);
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002682}
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002683
Steve Naroffcadebd02007-08-30 18:14:25 +00002684/// getVariableArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to the type for a
2685/// variable array of the specified element type.
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00002686QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy,
2687 Expr *NumElts,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002688 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002689 unsigned IndexTypeQuals,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002690 SourceRange Brackets) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002691 // Since we don't unique expressions, it isn't possible to unique VLA's
2692 // that have an expression provided for their size.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002693 QualType Canon;
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002694
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002695 // Be sure to pull qualifiers off the element type.
2696 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2697 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002698 Canon = getVariableArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), NumElts, ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002699 IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002700 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002701 }
2702
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002703 VariableArrayType *New = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002704 VariableArrayType(EltTy, Canon, NumElts, ASM, IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002705
2706 VariableArrayTypes.push_back(New);
2707 Types.push_back(New);
2708 return QualType(New, 0);
2709}
2710
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002711/// getDependentSizedArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to
2712/// the type for a dependently-sized array of the specified element
Douglas Gregorf3f95522009-07-31 00:23:35 +00002713/// type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002714QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType,
2715 Expr *numElements,
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002716 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002717 unsigned elementTypeQuals,
2718 SourceRange brackets) const {
2719 assert((!numElements || numElements->isTypeDependent() ||
2720 numElements->isValueDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002721 "Size must be type- or value-dependent!");
2722
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002723 // Dependently-sized array types that do not have a specified number
2724 // of elements will have their sizes deduced from a dependent
2725 // initializer. We do no canonicalization here at all, which is okay
2726 // because they can't be used in most locations.
2727 if (!numElements) {
2728 DependentSizedArrayType *newType
2729 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2730 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, QualType(),
2731 numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2732 brackets);
2733 Types.push_back(newType);
2734 return QualType(newType, 0);
2735 }
2736
2737 // Otherwise, we actually build a new type every time, but we
2738 // also build a canonical type.
2739
2740 SplitQualType canonElementType = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
2741
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002742 void *insertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002743 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002744 DependentSizedArrayType::Profile(ID, *this,
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002745 QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002746 ASM, elementTypeQuals, numElements);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002747
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002748 // Look for an existing type with these properties.
2749 DependentSizedArrayType *canonTy =
2750 DependentSizedArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002751
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002752 // If we don't have one, build one.
2753 if (!canonTy) {
2754 canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002755 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002756 QualType(), numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2757 brackets);
2758 DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
2759 Types.push_back(canonTy);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002760 }
2761
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002762 // Apply qualifiers from the element type to the array.
2763 QualType canon = getQualifiedType(QualType(canonTy,0),
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002764 canonElementType.Quals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002765
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002766 // If we didn't need extra canonicalization for the element type,
2767 // then just use that as our result.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002768 if (QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) == elementType)
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002769 return canon;
2770
2771 // Otherwise, we need to build a type which follows the spelling
2772 // of the element type.
2773 DependentSizedArrayType *sugaredType
2774 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2775 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, canon, numElements,
2776 ASM, elementTypeQuals, brackets);
2777 Types.push_back(sugaredType);
2778 return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002779}
2780
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002781QualType ASTContext::getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType,
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002782 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002783 unsigned elementTypeQuals) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002784 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002785 IncompleteArrayType::Profile(ID, elementType, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002786
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002787 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002788 if (IncompleteArrayType *iat =
2789 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos))
2790 return QualType(iat, 0);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002791
2792 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002793 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. We also have to pull
2794 // qualifiers off the element type.
2795 QualType canon;
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002796
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002797 if (!elementType.isCanonical() || elementType.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2798 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002799 canon = getIncompleteArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002800 ASM, elementTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002801 canon = getQualifiedType(canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002802
2803 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002804 IncompleteArrayType *existing =
2805 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2806 assert(!existing && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void) existing;
Ted Kremenek843ebedd2007-10-29 23:37:31 +00002807 }
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002808
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002809 IncompleteArrayType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2810 IncompleteArrayType(elementType, canon, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002811
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002812 IncompleteArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos);
2813 Types.push_back(newType);
2814 return QualType(newType, 0);
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002815}
2816
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002817/// getVectorType - Return the unique reference to a vector type of
2818/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
John Thompson22334602010-02-05 00:12:22 +00002819QualType ASTContext::getVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002820 VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002821 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002822
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002823 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2824 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002825 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::Vector, VecKind);
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002826
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002827 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002828 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2829 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2830
2831 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2832 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2833 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00002834 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Bob Wilson77954802010-11-16 00:32:20 +00002835 Canonical = getVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts, VecKind);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002836
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002837 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2838 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002839 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002840 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002841 VectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002842 VectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical, VecKind);
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002843 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2844 Types.push_back(New);
2845 return QualType(New, 0);
2846}
2847
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002848/// getExtVectorType - Return the unique reference to an extended vector type of
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002849/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002850QualType
2851ASTContext::getExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts) const {
Douglas Gregor39c02722011-06-15 16:02:29 +00002852 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() || vecType->isDependentType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002853
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002854 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2855 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002856 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::ExtVector,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002857 VectorType::GenericVector);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002858 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002859 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2860 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2861
2862 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2863 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2864 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002865 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002866 Canonical = getExtVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002867
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002868 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2869 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002870 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002871 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002872 ExtVectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2873 ExtVectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical);
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002874 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2875 Types.push_back(New);
2876 return QualType(New, 0);
2877}
2878
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002879QualType
2880ASTContext::getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType,
2881 Expr *SizeExpr,
2882 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002883 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002884 DependentSizedExtVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(vecType),
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002885 SizeExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002886
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002887 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002888 DependentSizedExtVectorType *Canon
2889 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2890 DependentSizedExtVectorType *New;
2891 if (Canon) {
2892 // We already have a canonical version of this array type; use it as
2893 // the canonical type for a newly-built type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002894 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2895 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(Canon, 0),
2896 SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002897 } else {
2898 QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(vecType);
2899 if (CanonVecTy == vecType) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002900 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2901 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(), SizeExpr,
2902 AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002903
2904 DependentSizedExtVectorType *CanonCheck
2905 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2906 assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized ext_vector canonical type broken");
2907 (void)CanonCheck;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002908 DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2909 } else {
2910 QualType Canon = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr,
2911 SourceLocation());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002912 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2913 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, Canon, SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002914 }
2915 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002916
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00002917 Types.push_back(New);
2918 return QualType(New, 0);
2919}
2920
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002921/// getFunctionNoProtoType - Return a K&R style C function type like 'int()'.
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002922///
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002923QualType
2924ASTContext::getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy,
2925 const FunctionType::ExtInfo &Info) const {
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00002926 const CallingConv CallConv = Info.getCC();
2927
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002928 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2929 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002930 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00002931 FunctionNoProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002932
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002933 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002934 if (FunctionNoProtoType *FT =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002935 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002936 return QualType(FT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002937
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002938 QualType Canonical;
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00002939 if (!ResultTy.isCanonical()) {
2940 Canonical = getFunctionNoProtoType(getCanonicalType(ResultTy), Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002941
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002942 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002943 FunctionNoProtoType *NewIP =
2944 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002945 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002946 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002947
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002948 FunctionProtoType::ExtInfo newInfo = Info.withCallingConv(CallConv);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002949 FunctionNoProtoType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002950 FunctionNoProtoType(ResultTy, Canonical, newInfo);
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002951 Types.push_back(New);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002952 FunctionNoProtoTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002953 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002954}
2955
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002956/// \brief Determine whether \p T is canonical as the result type of a function.
2957static bool isCanonicalResultType(QualType T) {
2958 return T.isCanonical() &&
2959 (T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None ||
2960 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone);
2961}
2962
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002963QualType
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002964ASTContext::getFunctionType(QualType ResultTy, ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002965 const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI) const {
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002966 size_t NumArgs = ArgArray.size();
2967
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002968 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2969 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002970 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002971 FunctionProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, ArgArray.begin(), NumArgs, EPI,
2972 *this);
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00002973
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002974 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002975 if (FunctionProtoType *FTP =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002976 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002977 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002978
2979 // Determine whether the type being created is already canonical or not.
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002980 bool isCanonical =
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00002981 EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_None && isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy) &&
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002982 !EPI.HasTrailingReturn;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002983 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs && isCanonical; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002984 if (!ArgArray[i].isCanonicalAsParam())
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002985 isCanonical = false;
2986
2987 // If this type isn't canonical, get the canonical version of it.
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002988 // The exception spec is not part of the canonical type.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002989 QualType Canonical;
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00002990 if (!isCanonical) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00002991 SmallVector<QualType, 16> CanonicalArgs;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002992 CanonicalArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
2993 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002994 CanonicalArgs.push_back(getCanonicalParamType(ArgArray[i]));
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002995
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002996 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo CanonicalEPI = EPI;
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002997 CanonicalEPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00002998 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec = FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo();
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002999
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00003000 // Result types do not have ARC lifetime qualifiers.
3001 QualType CanResultTy = getCanonicalType(ResultTy);
3002 if (ResultTy.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) {
3003 Qualifiers Qs = CanResultTy.getQualifiers();
3004 Qs.removeObjCLifetime();
3005 CanResultTy = getQualifiedType(CanResultTy.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
3006 }
3007
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003008 Canonical = getFunctionType(CanResultTy, CanonicalArgs, CanonicalEPI);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003009
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00003010 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003011 FunctionProtoType *NewIP =
3012 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003013 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003014 }
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003015
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003016 // FunctionProtoType objects are allocated with extra bytes after
3017 // them for three variable size arrays at the end:
3018 // - parameter types
3019 // - exception types
3020 // - consumed-arguments flags
3021 // Instead of the exception types, there could be a noexcept
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00003022 // expression, or information used to resolve the exception
3023 // specification.
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003024 size_t Size = sizeof(FunctionProtoType) +
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00003025 NumArgs * sizeof(QualType);
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003026 if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Dynamic) {
3027 Size += EPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions.size() * sizeof(QualType);
3028 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_ComputedNoexcept) {
Sebastian Redl31ad7542011-03-13 17:09:40 +00003029 Size += sizeof(Expr*);
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003030 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Uninstantiated) {
Richard Smithd3729422012-04-19 00:08:28 +00003031 Size += 2 * sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003032 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Unevaluated) {
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00003033 Size += sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00003034 }
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00003035 if (EPI.ConsumedParameters)
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003036 Size += NumArgs * sizeof(bool);
3037
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003038 FunctionProtoType *FTP = (FunctionProtoType*) Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00003039 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo newEPI = EPI;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003040 new (FTP) FunctionProtoType(ResultTy, ArgArray, Canonical, newEPI);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003041 Types.push_back(FTP);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003042 FunctionProtoTypes.InsertNode(FTP, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003043 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003044}
Chris Lattneref51c202006-11-10 07:17:23 +00003045
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003046#ifndef NDEBUG
3047static bool NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl *D) {
3048 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) return false;
3049 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
3050 if (isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(RD))
3051 return true;
3052 if (RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() &&
3053 !isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD))
3054 return true;
3055 return false;
3056}
3057#endif
3058
3059/// getInjectedClassNameType - Return the unique reference to the
3060/// injected class name type for the specified templated declaration.
3061QualType ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *Decl,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003062 QualType TST) const {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003063 assert(NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Decl));
3064 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) {
3065 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003066 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003067 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous declaration has no type");
3068 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3069 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
3070 } else {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003071 Type *newType =
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00003072 new (*this, TypeAlignment) InjectedClassNameType(Decl, TST);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003073 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3074 Types.push_back(newType);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003075 }
3076 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3077}
3078
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003079/// getTypeDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3080/// specified type declaration.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003081QualType ASTContext::getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis89656d22008-10-16 16:50:47 +00003082 assert(Decl && "Passed null for Decl param");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003083 assert(!Decl->TypeForDecl && "TypeForDecl present in slow case");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003084
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003085 if (const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Decl))
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003086 return getTypedefType(Typedef);
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003087
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003088 assert(!isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Decl) &&
3089 "Template type parameter types are always available.");
3090
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003091 if (const RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00003092 assert(Record->isFirstDecl() && "struct/union has previous declaration");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003093 assert(!NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Record));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003094 return getRecordType(Record);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003095 } else if (const EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00003096 assert(Enum->isFirstDecl() && "enum has previous declaration");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003097 return getEnumType(Enum);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003098 } else if (const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *Using =
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00003099 dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Decl)) {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003100 Type *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnresolvedUsingType(Using);
3101 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3102 Types.push_back(newType);
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00003103 } else
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003104 llvm_unreachable("TypeDecl without a type?");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00003105
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00003106 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003107}
3108
Chris Lattner32d920b2007-01-26 02:01:53 +00003109/// getTypedefType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003110/// specified typedef name decl.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003111QualType
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003112ASTContext::getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
3113 QualType Canonical) const {
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003114 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003115
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003116 if (Canonical.isNull())
3117 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003118 TypedefType *newType = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003119 TypedefType(Type::Typedef, Decl, Canonical);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003120 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3121 Types.push_back(newType);
3122 return QualType(newType, 0);
Chris Lattnerd0342e52006-11-20 04:02:15 +00003123}
3124
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003125QualType ASTContext::getRecordType(const RecordDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003126 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3127
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003128 if (const RecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003129 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3130 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3131
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003132 RecordType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RecordType(Decl);
3133 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3134 Types.push_back(newType);
3135 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003136}
3137
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003138QualType ASTContext::getEnumType(const EnumDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003139 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3140
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003141 if (const EnumDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003142 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3143 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3144
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003145 EnumType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) EnumType(Decl);
3146 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3147 Types.push_back(newType);
3148 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003149}
3150
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003151QualType ASTContext::getAttributedType(AttributedType::Kind attrKind,
3152 QualType modifiedType,
3153 QualType equivalentType) {
3154 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID id;
3155 AttributedType::Profile(id, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3156
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003157 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003158 AttributedType *type = AttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(id, insertPos);
3159 if (type) return QualType(type, 0);
3160
3161 QualType canon = getCanonicalType(equivalentType);
3162 type = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3163 AttributedType(canon, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3164
3165 Types.push_back(type);
3166 AttributedTypes.InsertNode(type, insertPos);
3167
3168 return QualType(type, 0);
3169}
3170
3171
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003172/// \brief Retrieve a substitution-result type.
3173QualType
3174ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003175 QualType Replacement) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00003176 assert(Replacement.isCanonical()
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003177 && "replacement types must always be canonical");
3178
3179 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3180 SubstTemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Parm, Replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003181 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003182 SubstTemplateTypeParmType *SubstParm
3183 = SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3184
3185 if (!SubstParm) {
3186 SubstParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3187 SubstTemplateTypeParmType(Parm, Replacement);
3188 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3189 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3190 }
3191
3192 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3193}
3194
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003195/// \brief Retrieve a
3196QualType ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(
3197 const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
3198 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) {
3199#ifndef NDEBUG
Aaron Ballman2a89e852014-07-15 21:32:31 +00003200 for (const auto &P : ArgPack.pack_elements()) {
3201 assert(P.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type &&"Pack contains a non-type");
3202 assert(P.getAsType().isCanonical() && "Pack contains non-canonical type");
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003203 }
3204#endif
3205
3206 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3207 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType::Profile(ID, Parm, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003208 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003209 if (SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3210 = SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3211 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3212
3213 QualType Canon;
3214 if (!Parm->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
3215 Canon = getCanonicalType(QualType(Parm, 0));
3216 Canon = getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(Canon),
3217 ArgPack);
3218 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3219 }
3220
3221 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3222 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Parm, Canon,
3223 ArgPack);
3224 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3225 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3226 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3227}
3228
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003229/// \brief Retrieve the template type parameter type for a template
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003230/// parameter or parameter pack with the given depth, index, and (optionally)
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003231/// name.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003232QualType ASTContext::getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth, unsigned Index,
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003233 bool ParameterPack,
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003234 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) const {
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003235 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003236 TemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Depth, Index, ParameterPack, TTPDecl);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003237 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003238 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeParm
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003239 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3240
3241 if (TypeParm)
3242 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003243
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003244 if (TTPDecl) {
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003245 QualType Canon = getTemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003246 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TemplateTypeParmType(TTPDecl, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003247
3248 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeCheck
3249 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3250 assert(!TypeCheck && "Template type parameter canonical type broken");
3251 (void)TypeCheck;
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003252 } else
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003253 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3254 TemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003255
3256 Types.push_back(TypeParm);
3257 TemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(TypeParm, InsertPos);
3258
3259 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
3260}
3261
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003262TypeSourceInfo *
3263ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name,
3264 SourceLocation NameLoc,
3265 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003266 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003267 assert(!Name.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3268 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003269 QualType TST = getTemplateSpecializationType(Name, Args, Underlying);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003270
3271 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(TST);
David Blaikie6adc78e2013-02-18 22:06:02 +00003272 TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL =
3273 DI->getTypeLoc().castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>();
Abramo Bagnara48c05be2012-02-06 14:41:24 +00003274 TL.setTemplateKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003275 TL.setTemplateNameLoc(NameLoc);
3276 TL.setLAngleLoc(Args.getLAngleLoc());
3277 TL.setRAngleLoc(Args.getRAngleLoc());
3278 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i)
3279 TL.setArgLocInfo(i, Args[i].getLocInfo());
3280 return DI;
3281}
3282
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003283QualType
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003284ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003285 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003286 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003287 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3288 "No dependent template names here!");
3289
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003290 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
3291
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003292 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> ArgVec;
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003293 ArgVec.reserve(NumArgs);
3294 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
3295 ArgVec.push_back(Args[i].getArgument());
3296
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00003297 return getTemplateSpecializationType(Template, ArgVec.data(), NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003298 Underlying);
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003299}
3300
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003301#ifndef NDEBUG
3302static bool hasAnyPackExpansions(const TemplateArgument *Args,
3303 unsigned NumArgs) {
3304 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3305 if (Args[I].isPackExpansion())
3306 return true;
3307
3308 return true;
3309}
3310#endif
3311
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003312QualType
3313ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003314 const TemplateArgument *Args,
3315 unsigned NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003316 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003317 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3318 "No dependent template names here!");
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003319 // Look through qualified template names.
3320 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3321 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003322
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003323 bool IsTypeAlias =
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003324 Template.getAsTemplateDecl() &&
3325 isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(Template.getAsTemplateDecl());
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003326 QualType CanonType;
3327 if (!Underlying.isNull())
3328 CanonType = getCanonicalType(Underlying);
3329 else {
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003330 // We can get here with an alias template when the specialization contains
3331 // a pack expansion that does not match up with a parameter pack.
3332 assert((!IsTypeAlias || hasAnyPackExpansions(Args, NumArgs)) &&
3333 "Caller must compute aliased type");
3334 IsTypeAlias = false;
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003335 CanonType = getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args,
3336 NumArgs);
3337 }
Douglas Gregord56a91e2009-02-26 22:19:44 +00003338
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003339 // Allocate the (non-canonical) template specialization type, but don't
3340 // try to unique it: these types typically have location information that
3341 // we don't unique and don't want to lose.
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003342 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3343 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs +
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003344 (IsTypeAlias? sizeof(QualType) : 0),
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003345 TypeAlignment);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003346 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003347 = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, NumArgs, CanonType,
3348 IsTypeAlias ? Underlying : QualType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003349
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003350 Types.push_back(Spec);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003351 return QualType(Spec, 0);
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003352}
3353
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003354QualType
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003355ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
3356 const TemplateArgument *Args,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003357 unsigned NumArgs) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003358 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3359 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003360
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003361 // Look through qualified template names.
3362 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3363 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003364
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003365 // Build the canonical template specialization type.
3366 TemplateName CanonTemplate = getCanonicalTemplateName(Template);
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003367 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> CanonArgs;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003368 CanonArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
3369 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3370 CanonArgs.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]));
3371
3372 // Determine whether this canonical template specialization type already
3373 // exists.
3374 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3375 TemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, CanonTemplate,
3376 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs, *this);
3377
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003378 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003379 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
3380 = TemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3381
3382 if (!Spec) {
3383 // Allocate a new canonical template specialization type.
3384 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3385 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3386 TypeAlignment);
3387 Spec = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(CanonTemplate,
3388 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003389 QualType(), QualType());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003390 Types.push_back(Spec);
3391 TemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(Spec, InsertPos);
3392 }
3393
3394 assert(Spec->isDependentType() &&
3395 "Non-dependent template-id type must have a canonical type");
3396 return QualType(Spec, 0);
3397}
3398
3399QualType
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003400ASTContext::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3401 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003402 QualType NamedType) const {
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003403 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003404 ElaboratedType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, NamedType);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003405
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003406 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003407 ElaboratedType *T = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003408 if (T)
3409 return QualType(T, 0);
3410
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003411 QualType Canon = NamedType;
3412 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3413 Canon = getCanonicalType(NamedType);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003414 ElaboratedType *CheckT = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3415 assert(!CheckT && "Elaborated canonical type broken");
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003416 (void)CheckT;
3417 }
3418
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00003419 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, NamedType, Canon);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003420 Types.push_back(T);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003421 ElaboratedTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003422 return QualType(T, 0);
3423}
3424
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003425QualType
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003426ASTContext::getParenType(QualType InnerType) const {
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003427 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3428 ParenType::Profile(ID, InnerType);
3429
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003430 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003431 ParenType *T = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3432 if (T)
3433 return QualType(T, 0);
3434
3435 QualType Canon = InnerType;
3436 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3437 Canon = getCanonicalType(InnerType);
3438 ParenType *CheckT = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3439 assert(!CheckT && "Paren canonical type broken");
3440 (void)CheckT;
3441 }
3442
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00003443 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ParenType(InnerType, Canon);
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003444 Types.push_back(T);
3445 ParenTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3446 return QualType(T, 0);
3447}
3448
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003449QualType ASTContext::getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3450 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3451 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003452 QualType Canon) const {
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003453 if (Canon.isNull()) {
3454 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003455 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3456 if (Keyword == ETK_None)
3457 CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3458
3459 if (CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword)
3460 Canon = getDependentNameType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003461 }
3462
3463 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003464 DependentNameType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003465
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003466 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003467 DependentNameType *T
3468 = DependentNameTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003469 if (T)
3470 return QualType(T, 0);
3471
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00003472 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentNameType(Keyword, NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003473 Types.push_back(T);
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003474 DependentNameTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003475 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003476}
3477
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003478QualType
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003479ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3480 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003481 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003482 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003483 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args) const {
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003484 // TODO: avoid this copy
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003485 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> ArgCopy;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003486 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Args.size(); I != E; ++I)
3487 ArgCopy.push_back(Args[I].getArgument());
3488 return getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, Name,
3489 ArgCopy.size(),
3490 ArgCopy.data());
3491}
3492
3493QualType
3494ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3495 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3496 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3497 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
3498 unsigned NumArgs,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003499 const TemplateArgument *Args) const {
Douglas Gregor6e068012011-02-28 00:04:36 +00003500 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
3501 "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003502
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003503 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003504 DependentTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, *this, Keyword, NNS,
3505 Name, NumArgs, Args);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003506
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003507 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003508 DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T
3509 = DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003510 if (T)
3511 return QualType(T, 0);
3512
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003513 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003514
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003515 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3516 if (Keyword == ETK_None) CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3517
3518 bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003519 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> CanonArgs(NumArgs);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003520 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) {
3521 CanonArgs[I] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]);
3522 if (!CanonArgs[I].structurallyEquals(Args[I]))
3523 AnyNonCanonArgs = true;
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003524 }
3525
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003526 QualType Canon;
3527 if (AnyNonCanonArgs || CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) {
3528 Canon = getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS,
3529 Name, NumArgs,
3530 CanonArgs.data());
3531
3532 // Find the insert position again.
3533 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3534 }
3535
3536 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType) +
3537 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3538 TypeAlignment);
John McCall773cc982010-06-11 11:07:21 +00003539 T = new (Mem) DependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003540 Name, NumArgs, Args, Canon);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003541 Types.push_back(T);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003542 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003543 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003544}
3545
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003546QualType ASTContext::getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern,
David Blaikie05785d12013-02-20 22:23:23 +00003547 Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions) {
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003548 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003549 PackExpansionType::Profile(ID, Pattern, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003550
3551 assert(Pattern->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() &&
3552 "Pack expansions must expand one or more parameter packs");
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003553 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003554 PackExpansionType *T
3555 = PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3556 if (T)
3557 return QualType(T, 0);
3558
3559 QualType Canon;
3560 if (!Pattern.isCanonical()) {
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003561 Canon = getCanonicalType(Pattern);
3562 // The canonical type might not contain an unexpanded parameter pack, if it
3563 // contains an alias template specialization which ignores one of its
3564 // parameters.
3565 if (Canon->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) {
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00003566 Canon = getPackExpansionType(Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003567
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003568 // Find the insert position again, in case we inserted an element into
3569 // PackExpansionTypes and invalidated our insert position.
3570 PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3571 }
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003572 }
3573
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00003574 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3575 PackExpansionType(Pattern, Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003576 Types.push_back(T);
3577 PackExpansionTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00003578 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003579}
3580
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003581/// CmpProtocolNames - Comparison predicate for sorting protocols
3582/// alphabetically.
Benjamin Kramer0eb262f2015-03-14 13:32:49 +00003583static int CmpProtocolNames(ObjCProtocolDecl *const *LHS,
3584 ObjCProtocolDecl *const *RHS) {
3585 return DeclarationName::compare((*LHS)->getDeclName(), (*RHS)->getDeclName());
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003586}
3587
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003588static bool areSortedAndUniqued(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003589 unsigned NumProtocols) {
3590 if (NumProtocols == 0) return true;
3591
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003592 if (Protocols[0]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[0])
3593 return false;
3594
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003595 for (unsigned i = 1; i != NumProtocols; ++i)
Benjamin Kramer0eb262f2015-03-14 13:32:49 +00003596 if (CmpProtocolNames(&Protocols[i - 1], &Protocols[i]) >= 0 ||
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003597 Protocols[i]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[i])
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003598 return false;
3599 return true;
3600}
3601
3602static void SortAndUniqueProtocols(ObjCProtocolDecl **Protocols,
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003603 unsigned &NumProtocols) {
3604 ObjCProtocolDecl **ProtocolsEnd = Protocols+NumProtocols;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003605
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003606 // Sort protocols, keyed by name.
Benjamin Kramer0eb262f2015-03-14 13:32:49 +00003607 llvm::array_pod_sort(Protocols, ProtocolsEnd, CmpProtocolNames);
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003608
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003609 // Canonicalize.
3610 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NumProtocols; I != N; ++I)
3611 Protocols[I] = Protocols[I]->getCanonicalDecl();
3612
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003613 // Remove duplicates.
3614 ProtocolsEnd = std::unique(Protocols, ProtocolsEnd);
3615 NumProtocols = ProtocolsEnd-Protocols;
3616}
3617
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003618QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType,
3619 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003620 unsigned NumProtocols) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003621 // If the base type is an interface and there aren't any protocols
3622 // to add, then the interface type will do just fine.
3623 if (!NumProtocols && isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(BaseType))
3624 return BaseType;
3625
3626 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003627 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003628 ObjCObjectTypeImpl::Profile(ID, BaseType, Protocols, NumProtocols);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003629 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003630 if (ObjCObjectType *QT = ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3631 return QualType(QT, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003632
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003633 // Build the canonical type, which has the canonical base type and
3634 // a sorted-and-uniqued list of protocols.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003635 QualType Canonical;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003636 bool ProtocolsSorted = areSortedAndUniqued(Protocols, NumProtocols);
3637 if (!ProtocolsSorted || !BaseType.isCanonical()) {
3638 if (!ProtocolsSorted) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003639 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> Sorted(Protocols,
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00003640 Protocols + NumProtocols);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003641 unsigned UniqueCount = NumProtocols;
3642
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003643 SortAndUniqueProtocols(&Sorted[0], UniqueCount);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003644 Canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(BaseType),
3645 &Sorted[0], UniqueCount);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003646 } else {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003647 Canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(BaseType),
3648 Protocols, NumProtocols);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003649 }
3650
3651 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003652 ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3653 }
3654
3655 unsigned Size = sizeof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl);
3656 Size += NumProtocols * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
3657 void *Mem = Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
3658 ObjCObjectTypeImpl *T =
3659 new (Mem) ObjCObjectTypeImpl(Canonical, BaseType, Protocols, NumProtocols);
3660
3661 Types.push_back(T);
3662 ObjCObjectTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3663 return QualType(T, 0);
3664}
3665
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003666/// ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols - Checks that protocols in IC's
3667/// protocol list adopt all protocols in QT's qualified-id protocol
3668/// list.
3669bool ASTContext::ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols(QualType QT,
3670 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC) {
3671 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3672 return false;
3673
3674 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
3675 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003676 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003677 if (!IC->ClassImplementsProtocol(Proto, false))
3678 return false;
3679 }
3680 return true;
3681 }
3682 return false;
3683}
3684
3685/// QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols - Checks that protocols in
3686/// QT's qualified-id protocol list adopt all protocols in IDecl's list
3687/// of protocols.
3688bool ASTContext::QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols(QualType QT,
3689 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl) {
3690 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3691 return false;
3692 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3693 if (!OPT)
3694 return false;
3695 if (!IDecl->hasDefinition())
3696 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00003697 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocols;
3698 CollectInheritedProtocols(IDecl, InheritedProtocols);
3699 if (InheritedProtocols.empty())
3700 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00003701 // Check that if every protocol in list of id<plist> conforms to a protcol
3702 // of IDecl's, then bridge casting is ok.
3703 bool Conforms = false;
3704 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
3705 Conforms = false;
3706 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
3707 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(Proto, PI)) {
3708 Conforms = true;
3709 break;
3710 }
3711 }
3712 if (!Conforms)
3713 break;
3714 }
3715 if (Conforms)
3716 return true;
3717
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003718 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003719 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
3720 bool Adopts = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003721 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00003722 // return 'true' if 'PI' is in the inheritance hierarchy of Proto
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003723 if ((Adopts = ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(PI, Proto)))
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003724 break;
3725 }
3726 if (!Adopts)
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00003727 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003728 }
3729 return true;
3730}
3731
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003732/// getObjCObjectPointerType - Return a ObjCObjectPointerType type for
3733/// the given object type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003734QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003735 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3736 ObjCObjectPointerType::Profile(ID, ObjectT);
3737
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003738 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003739 if (ObjCObjectPointerType *QT =
3740 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3741 return QualType(QT, 0);
3742
3743 // Find the canonical object type.
3744 QualType Canonical;
3745 if (!ObjectT.isCanonical()) {
3746 Canonical = getObjCObjectPointerType(getCanonicalType(ObjectT));
3747
3748 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003749 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3750 }
3751
Douglas Gregorf85bee62010-02-08 22:59:26 +00003752 // No match.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003753 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCObjectPointerType), TypeAlignment);
3754 ObjCObjectPointerType *QType =
3755 new (Mem) ObjCObjectPointerType(Canonical, ObjectT);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003756
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003757 Types.push_back(QType);
3758 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.InsertNode(QType, InsertPos);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003759 return QualType(QType, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003760}
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003761
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003762/// getObjCInterfaceType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3763/// specified ObjC interface decl. The list of protocols is optional.
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003764QualType ASTContext::getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl,
3765 ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevDecl) const {
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003766 if (Decl->TypeForDecl)
3767 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003768
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003769 if (PrevDecl) {
3770 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous decl has no TypeForDecl");
3771 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3772 return QualType(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3773 }
3774
Douglas Gregor7671e532011-12-16 16:34:57 +00003775 // Prefer the definition, if there is one.
3776 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Decl->getDefinition())
3777 Decl = Def;
3778
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003779 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCInterfaceType), TypeAlignment);
3780 ObjCInterfaceType *T = new (Mem) ObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
3781 Decl->TypeForDecl = T;
3782 Types.push_back(T);
3783 return QualType(T, 0);
Fariborz Jahanian70e8f102007-10-11 00:55:41 +00003784}
3785
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003786/// getTypeOfExprType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we can't unique
3787/// TypeOfExprType AST's (since expression's are never shared). For example,
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003788/// multiple declarations that refer to "typeof(x)" all contain different
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003789/// DeclRefExpr's. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003790/// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003791QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfExprType(Expr *tofExpr) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003792 TypeOfExprType *toe;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003793 if (tofExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
3794 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3795 DependentTypeOfExprType::Profile(ID, *this, tofExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003796
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003797 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003798 DependentTypeOfExprType *Canon
3799 = DependentTypeOfExprTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3800 if (Canon) {
3801 // We already have a "canonical" version of an identical, dependent
3802 // typeof(expr) type. Use that as our canonical type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003803 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr,
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003804 QualType((TypeOfExprType*)Canon, 0));
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00003805 } else {
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003806 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003807 Canon
3808 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentTypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr);
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003809 DependentTypeOfExprTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
3810 toe = Canon;
3811 }
3812 } else {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003813 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofExpr->getType());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003814 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, Canonical);
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003815 }
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003816 Types.push_back(toe);
3817 return QualType(toe, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003818}
3819
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003820/// getTypeOfType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003821/// TypeOfType nodes. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003822/// memory savings. Since typeof(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003823/// an issue. This doesn't affect the type checker, since it operates
3824/// on canonical types (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003825QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfType(QualType tofType) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00003826 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofType);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003827 TypeOfType *tot = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfType(tofType, Canonical);
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003828 Types.push_back(tot);
3829 return QualType(tot, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003830}
3831
Anders Carlssonad6bd352009-06-24 21:24:56 +00003832
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003833/// \brief Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique DecltypeType
3834/// nodes. This would never be helpful, since each such type has its own
3835/// expression, and would not give a significant memory saving, since there
3836/// is an Expr tree under each such type.
Douglas Gregor81495f32012-02-12 18:42:33 +00003837QualType ASTContext::getDecltypeType(Expr *e, QualType UnderlyingType) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003838 DecltypeType *dt;
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003839
3840 // C++11 [temp.type]p2:
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00003841 // If an expression e involves a template parameter, decltype(e) denotes a
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003842 // unique dependent type. Two such decltype-specifiers refer to the same
3843 // type only if their expressions are equivalent (14.5.6.1).
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00003844 if (e->isInstantiationDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003845 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3846 DependentDecltypeType::Profile(ID, *this, e);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003847
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003848 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003849 DependentDecltypeType *Canon
3850 = DependentDecltypeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003851 if (!Canon) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003852 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003853 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentDecltypeType(*this, e);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003854 DependentDecltypeTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003855 }
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003856 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3857 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, QualType((DecltypeType *)Canon, 0));
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003858 } else {
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003859 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3860 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003861 }
Anders Carlsson81df7b82009-06-24 19:06:50 +00003862 Types.push_back(dt);
3863 return QualType(dt, 0);
3864}
3865
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00003866/// getUnaryTransformationType - We don't unique these, since the memory
3867/// savings are minimal and these are rare.
3868QualType ASTContext::getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType,
3869 QualType UnderlyingType,
3870 UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind)
3871 const {
3872 UnaryTransformType *Ty =
Douglas Gregor6c6e6762011-05-25 17:51:54 +00003873 new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType, UnderlyingType,
3874 Kind,
3875 UnderlyingType->isDependentType() ?
Peter Collingbourne15d48ec2012-03-05 16:02:06 +00003876 QualType() : getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00003877 Types.push_back(Ty);
3878 return QualType(Ty, 0);
3879}
3880
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003881/// getAutoType - Return the uniqued reference to the 'auto' type which has been
3882/// deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 'auto' type, or the
3883/// canonical deduced-but-dependent 'auto' type.
3884QualType ASTContext::getAutoType(QualType DeducedType, bool IsDecltypeAuto,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003885 bool IsDependent) const {
3886 if (DeducedType.isNull() && !IsDecltypeAuto && !IsDependent)
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003887 return getAutoDeductType();
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003888
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003889 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003890 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003891 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003892 AutoType::Profile(ID, DeducedType, IsDecltypeAuto, IsDependent);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003893 if (AutoType *AT = AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3894 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00003895
Richard Smith74aeef52013-04-26 16:15:35 +00003896 AutoType *AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(DeducedType,
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00003897 IsDecltypeAuto,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003898 IsDependent);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00003899 Types.push_back(AT);
3900 if (InsertPos)
3901 AutoTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
3902 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00003903}
3904
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00003905/// getAtomicType - Return the uniqued reference to the atomic type for
3906/// the given value type.
3907QualType ASTContext::getAtomicType(QualType T) const {
3908 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
3909 // structure.
3910 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3911 AtomicType::Profile(ID, T);
3912
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003913 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00003914 if (AtomicType *AT = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3915 return QualType(AT, 0);
3916
3917 // If the atomic value type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
3918 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3919 QualType Canonical;
3920 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
3921 Canonical = getAtomicType(getCanonicalType(T));
3922
3923 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3924 AtomicType *NewIP = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003925 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00003926 }
3927 AtomicType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AtomicType(T, Canonical);
3928 Types.push_back(New);
3929 AtomicTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3930 return QualType(New, 0);
3931}
3932
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00003933/// getAutoDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto'.
3934QualType ASTContext::getAutoDeductType() const {
3935 if (AutoDeductTy.isNull())
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003936 AutoDeductTy = QualType(
3937 new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(QualType(), /*decltype(auto)*/false,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003938 /*dependent*/false),
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003939 0);
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00003940 return AutoDeductTy;
3941}
3942
3943/// getAutoRRefDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto &&'.
3944QualType ASTContext::getAutoRRefDeductType() const {
3945 if (AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull())
3946 AutoRRefDeductTy = getRValueReferenceType(getAutoDeductType());
3947 assert(!AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull() && "can't build 'auto &&' pattern");
3948 return AutoRRefDeductTy;
3949}
3950
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003951/// getTagDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3952/// specified TagDecl (struct/union/class/enum) decl.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003953QualType ASTContext::getTagDeclType(const TagDecl *Decl) const {
Ted Kremenek2b0ce112007-11-26 21:16:01 +00003954 assert (Decl);
Mike Stumpb93185d2009-08-07 18:05:12 +00003955 // FIXME: What is the design on getTagDeclType when it requires casting
3956 // away const? mutable?
3957 return getTypeDeclType(const_cast<TagDecl*>(Decl));
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003958}
3959
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003960/// getSizeType - Return the unique type for "size_t" (C99 7.17), the result
3961/// of the sizeof operator (C99 6.5.3.4p4). The value is target dependent and
3962/// needs to agree with the definition in <stddef.h>.
Anders Carlsson22f443f2009-12-12 00:26:23 +00003963CanQualType ASTContext::getSizeType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00003964 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSizeType());
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00003965}
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003966
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00003967/// getIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "intmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
3968CanQualType ASTContext::getIntMaxType() const {
3969 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntMaxType());
3970}
3971
3972/// getUIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "uintmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
3973CanQualType ASTContext::getUIntMaxType() const {
3974 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUIntMaxType());
3975}
3976
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00003977/// getSignedWCharType - Return the type of "signed wchar_t".
3978/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
3979QualType ASTContext::getSignedWCharType() const {
3980 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
3981 return WCharTy;
3982}
3983
3984/// getUnsignedWCharType - Return the type of "unsigned wchar_t".
3985/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
3986QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedWCharType() const {
3987 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
3988 return UnsignedIntTy;
3989}
3990
Enea Zaffanellaf11ceb62013-01-26 17:08:37 +00003991QualType ASTContext::getIntPtrType() const {
3992 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntPtrType());
3993}
3994
3995QualType ASTContext::getUIntPtrType() const {
3996 return getCorrespondingUnsignedType(getIntPtrType());
3997}
3998
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00003999/// getPointerDiffType - Return the unique type for "ptrdiff_t" (C99 7.17)
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00004000/// defined in <stddef.h>. Pointer - pointer requires this (C99 6.5.6p9).
4001QualType ASTContext::getPointerDiffType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00004002 return getFromTargetType(Target->getPtrDiffType(0));
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00004003}
4004
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00004005/// \brief Return the unique type for "pid_t" defined in
4006/// <sys/types.h>. We need this to compute the correct type for vfork().
4007QualType ASTContext::getProcessIDType() const {
4008 return getFromTargetType(Target->getProcessIDType());
4009}
4010
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004011//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
4012// Type Operators
4013//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
4014
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004015CanQualType ASTContext::getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const {
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004016 // Push qualifiers into arrays, and then discard any remaining
4017 // qualifiers.
4018 T = getCanonicalType(T);
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00004019 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004020 const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr();
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004021 QualType Result;
4022 if (isa<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
4023 Result = getArrayDecayedType(QualType(Ty,0));
4024 } else if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) {
4025 Result = getPointerType(QualType(Ty, 0));
4026 } else {
4027 Result = QualType(Ty, 0);
4028 }
4029
4030 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(Result);
4031}
4032
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004033QualType ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type,
4034 Qualifiers &quals) {
4035 SplitQualType splitType = type.getSplitUnqualifiedType();
4036
4037 // FIXME: getSplitUnqualifiedType() actually walks all the way to
4038 // the unqualified desugared type and then drops it on the floor.
4039 // We then have to strip that sugar back off with
4040 // getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), which is silly.
4041 const ArrayType *AT =
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004042 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(splitType.Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004043
4044 // If we don't have an array, just use the results in splitType.
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004045 if (!AT) {
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004046 quals = splitType.Quals;
4047 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004048 }
4049
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004050 // Otherwise, recurse on the array's element type.
4051 QualType elementType = AT->getElementType();
4052 QualType unqualElementType = getUnqualifiedArrayType(elementType, quals);
4053
4054 // If that didn't change the element type, AT has no qualifiers, so we
4055 // can just use the results in splitType.
4056 if (elementType == unqualElementType) {
4057 assert(quals.empty()); // from the recursive call
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004058 quals = splitType.Quals;
4059 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004060 }
4061
4062 // Otherwise, add in the qualifiers from the outermost type, then
4063 // build the type back up.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004064 quals.addConsistentQualifiers(splitType.Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004065
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004066 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004067 return getConstantArrayType(unqualElementType, CAT->getSize(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004068 CAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
4069 }
4070
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004071 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004072 return getIncompleteArrayType(unqualElementType, IAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004073 }
4074
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004075 if (const VariableArrayType *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004076 return getVariableArrayType(unqualElementType,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004077 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004078 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
4079 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
4080 VAT->getBracketsRange());
4081 }
4082
4083 const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(AT);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004084 return getDependentSizedArrayType(unqualElementType, DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004085 DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 0,
4086 SourceRange());
4087}
4088
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00004089/// UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes - If T1 and T2 are pointer types that
4090/// may be similar (C++ 4.4), replaces T1 and T2 with the type that
4091/// they point to and return true. If T1 and T2 aren't pointer types
4092/// or pointer-to-member types, or if they are not similar at this
4093/// level, returns false and leaves T1 and T2 unchanged. Top-level
4094/// qualifiers on T1 and T2 are ignored. This function will typically
4095/// be called in a loop that successively "unwraps" pointer and
4096/// pointer-to-member types to compare them at each level.
4097bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) {
4098 const PointerType *T1PtrType = T1->getAs<PointerType>(),
4099 *T2PtrType = T2->getAs<PointerType>();
4100 if (T1PtrType && T2PtrType) {
4101 T1 = T1PtrType->getPointeeType();
4102 T2 = T2PtrType->getPointeeType();
4103 return true;
4104 }
4105
4106 const MemberPointerType *T1MPType = T1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
4107 *T2MPType = T2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
4108 if (T1MPType && T2MPType &&
4109 hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(T1MPType->getClass(), 0),
4110 QualType(T2MPType->getClass(), 0))) {
4111 T1 = T1MPType->getPointeeType();
4112 T2 = T2MPType->getPointeeType();
4113 return true;
4114 }
4115
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00004116 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00004117 const ObjCObjectPointerType *T1OPType = T1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
4118 *T2OPType = T2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4119 if (T1OPType && T2OPType) {
4120 T1 = T1OPType->getPointeeType();
4121 T2 = T2OPType->getPointeeType();
4122 return true;
4123 }
4124 }
4125
4126 // FIXME: Block pointers, too?
4127
4128 return false;
4129}
4130
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004131DeclarationNameInfo
4132ASTContext::getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name,
4133 SourceLocation NameLoc) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004134 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4135 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4136 case TemplateName::Template:
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004137 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004138 return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsTemplateDecl()->getDeclName(),
4139 NameLoc);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004140
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004141 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: {
4142 OverloadedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsOverloadedTemplate();
4143 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
4144 return DeclarationNameInfo((*Storage->begin())->getDeclName(), NameLoc);
4145 }
4146
4147 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4148 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004149 DeclarationName DName;
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004150 if (DTN->isIdentifier()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004151 DName = DeclarationNames.getIdentifier(DTN->getIdentifier());
4152 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004153 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004154 DName = DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(DTN->getOperator());
4155 // DNInfo work in progress: FIXME: source locations?
4156 DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc;
4157 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4158 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4159 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc, DNLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004160 }
4161 }
4162
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004163 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4164 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4165 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4166 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameter()->getDeclName(),
4167 NameLoc);
4168 }
4169
4170 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4171 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4172 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4173 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameterPack()->getDeclName(),
4174 NameLoc);
4175 }
4176 }
4177
4178 llvm_unreachable("bad template name kind!");
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004179}
4180
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004181TemplateName ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateName(TemplateName Name) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004182 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4183 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4184 case TemplateName::Template: {
4185 TemplateDecl *Template = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004186 if (TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004187 = dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Template))
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004188 Template = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TTP);
4189
4190 // The canonical template name is the canonical template declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6b7e3762009-07-18 00:34:25 +00004191 return TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(Template->getCanonicalDecl()));
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004192 }
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004193
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004194 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate:
4195 llvm_unreachable("cannot canonicalize overloaded template");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004196
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004197 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4198 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
4199 assert(DTN && "Non-dependent template names must refer to template decls.");
4200 return DTN->CanonicalTemplateName;
4201 }
4202
4203 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4204 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4205 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4206 return getCanonicalTemplateName(subst->getReplacement());
4207 }
4208
4209 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4210 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4211 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4212 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *canonParameter
4213 = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(subst->getParameterPack());
4214 TemplateArgument canonArgPack
4215 = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(subst->getArgumentPack());
4216 return getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(canonParameter, canonArgPack);
4217 }
4218 }
4219
4220 llvm_unreachable("bad template name!");
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004221}
4222
Douglas Gregoradee3e32009-11-11 23:06:43 +00004223bool ASTContext::hasSameTemplateName(TemplateName X, TemplateName Y) {
4224 X = getCanonicalTemplateName(X);
4225 Y = getCanonicalTemplateName(Y);
4226 return X.getAsVoidPointer() == Y.getAsVoidPointer();
4227}
4228
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004229TemplateArgument
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004230ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) const {
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004231 switch (Arg.getKind()) {
4232 case TemplateArgument::Null:
4233 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004234
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004235 case TemplateArgument::Expression:
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004236 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004237
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004238 case TemplateArgument::Declaration: {
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004239 ValueDecl *D = cast<ValueDecl>(Arg.getAsDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
David Blaikie952a9b12014-10-17 18:00:12 +00004240 return TemplateArgument(D, Arg.getParamTypeForDecl());
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004241 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004242
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004243 case TemplateArgument::NullPtr:
4244 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getNullPtrType()),
4245 /*isNullPtr*/true);
4246
Douglas Gregor9167f8b2009-11-11 01:00:40 +00004247 case TemplateArgument::Template:
4248 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplate()));
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004249
4250 case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion:
4251 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(
4252 Arg.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern()),
Douglas Gregore1d60df2011-01-14 23:41:42 +00004253 Arg.getNumTemplateExpansions());
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004254
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004255 case TemplateArgument::Integral:
Benjamin Kramer6003ad52012-06-07 15:09:51 +00004256 return TemplateArgument(Arg, getCanonicalType(Arg.getIntegralType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004257
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004258 case TemplateArgument::Type:
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00004259 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getAsType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004260
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004261 case TemplateArgument::Pack: {
Douglas Gregor0192c232010-12-20 16:52:59 +00004262 if (Arg.pack_size() == 0)
4263 return Arg;
4264
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00004265 TemplateArgument *CanonArgs
4266 = new (*this) TemplateArgument[Arg.pack_size()];
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004267 unsigned Idx = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004268 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator A = Arg.pack_begin(),
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004269 AEnd = Arg.pack_end();
4270 A != AEnd; (void)++A, ++Idx)
4271 CanonArgs[Idx] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(*A);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004272
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00004273 return TemplateArgument(CanonArgs, Arg.pack_size());
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004274 }
4275 }
4276
4277 // Silence GCC warning
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004278 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled template argument kind");
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004279}
4280
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004281NestedNameSpecifier *
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004282ASTContext::getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004283 if (!NNS)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004284 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004285
4286 switch (NNS->getKind()) {
4287 case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
4288 // Canonicalize the prefix but keep the identifier the same.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004289 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this,
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004290 getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS->getPrefix()),
4291 NNS->getAsIdentifier());
4292
4293 case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
4294 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4295 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004296 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004297 NNS->getAsNamespace()->getOriginalNamespace());
4298
4299 case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
4300 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4301 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004302 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004303 NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias()->getNamespace()
4304 ->getOriginalNamespace());
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004305
4306 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
4307 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: {
4308 QualType T = getCanonicalType(QualType(NNS->getAsType(), 0));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004309
4310 // If we have some kind of dependent-named type (e.g., "typename T::type"),
4311 // break it apart into its prefix and identifier, then reconsititute those
4312 // as the canonical nested-name-specifier. This is required to canonicalize
4313 // a dependent nested-name-specifier involving typedefs of dependent-name
4314 // types, e.g.,
4315 // typedef typename T::type T1;
4316 // typedef typename T1::type T2;
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004317 if (const DependentNameType *DNT = T->getAs<DependentNameType>())
4318 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DNT->getQualifier(),
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004319 const_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(DNT->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004320
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004321 // Otherwise, just canonicalize the type, and force it to be a TypeSpec.
4322 // FIXME: Why are TypeSpec and TypeSpecWithTemplate distinct in the
4323 // first place?
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004324 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr, false,
4325 const_cast<Type *>(T.getTypePtr()));
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004326 }
4327
4328 case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
Nikola Smiljanic67860242014-09-26 00:28:20 +00004329 case NestedNameSpecifier::Super:
4330 // The global specifier and __super specifer are canonical and unique.
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004331 return NNS;
4332 }
4333
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00004334 llvm_unreachable("Invalid NestedNameSpecifier::Kind!");
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004335}
4336
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004337
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004338const ArrayType *ASTContext::getAsArrayType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004339 // Handle the non-qualified case efficiently.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004340 if (!T.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004341 // Handle the common positive case fast.
4342 if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(T))
4343 return AT;
4344 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004345
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004346 // Handle the common negative case fast.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004347 if (!isa<ArrayType>(T.getCanonicalType()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004348 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004349
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004350 // Apply any qualifiers from the array type to the element type. This
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004351 // implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of an array type includes
4352 // any type qualifiers, the element type is so qualified, not the array type."
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004353
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004354 // If we get here, we either have type qualifiers on the type, or we have
4355 // sugar such as a typedef in the way. If we have type qualifiers on the type
Douglas Gregor2211d342009-08-05 05:36:45 +00004356 // we must propagate them down into the element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004357
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004358 SplitQualType split = T.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004359 Qualifiers qs = split.Quals;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004360
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004361 // If we have a simple case, just return now.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004362 const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(split.Ty);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004363 if (!ATy || qs.empty())
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004364 return ATy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004365
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004366 // Otherwise, we have an array and we have qualifiers on it. Push the
4367 // qualifiers into the array element type and return a new array type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004368 QualType NewEltTy = getQualifiedType(ATy->getElementType(), qs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004369
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004370 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(ATy))
4371 return cast<ArrayType>(getConstantArrayType(NewEltTy, CAT->getSize(),
4372 CAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004373 CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004374 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ATy))
4375 return cast<ArrayType>(getIncompleteArrayType(NewEltTy,
4376 IAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004377 IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004378
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004379 if (const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004380 = dyn_cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ATy))
4381 return cast<ArrayType>(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004382 getDependentSizedArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004383 DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004384 DSAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004385 DSAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004386 DSAT->getBracketsRange()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004387
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004388 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(ATy);
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004389 return cast<ArrayType>(getVariableArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004390 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004391 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004392 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004393 VAT->getBracketsRange()));
Chris Lattnered0d0792008-04-06 22:41:35 +00004394}
4395
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004396QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const {
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00004397 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4398 return getDecayedType(T);
4399 return T;
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004400}
4401
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004402QualType ASTContext::getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004403 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4404 T = getAdjustedParameterType(T);
4405 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4406}
4407
David Majnemerd09a51c2015-03-03 01:50:05 +00004408QualType ASTContext::getExceptionObjectType(QualType T) const {
4409 // C++ [except.throw]p3:
4410 // A throw-expression initializes a temporary object, called the exception
4411 // object, the type of which is determined by removing any top-level
4412 // cv-qualifiers from the static type of the operand of throw and adjusting
4413 // the type from "array of T" or "function returning T" to "pointer to T"
4414 // or "pointer to function returning T", [...]
4415 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4416 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4417 T = getDecayedType(T);
4418 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4419}
4420
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004421/// getArrayDecayedType - Return the properly qualified result of decaying the
4422/// specified array type to a pointer. This operation is non-trivial when
4423/// handling typedefs etc. The canonical type of "T" must be an array type,
4424/// this returns a pointer to a properly qualified element of the array.
4425///
4426/// See C99 6.7.5.3p7 and C99 6.3.2.1p3.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004427QualType ASTContext::getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004428 // Get the element type with 'getAsArrayType' so that we don't lose any
4429 // typedefs in the element type of the array. This also handles propagation
4430 // of type qualifiers from the array type into the element type if present
4431 // (C99 6.7.3p8).
4432 const ArrayType *PrettyArrayType = getAsArrayType(Ty);
4433 assert(PrettyArrayType && "Not an array type!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004434
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004435 QualType PtrTy = getPointerType(PrettyArrayType->getElementType());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004436
4437 // int x[restrict 4] -> int *restrict
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004438 return getQualifiedType(PtrTy, PrettyArrayType->getIndexTypeQualifiers());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004439}
4440
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004441QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(const ArrayType *array) const {
4442 return getBaseElementType(array->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor79f83ed2009-07-23 23:49:00 +00004443}
4444
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004445QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(QualType type) const {
4446 Qualifiers qs;
4447 while (true) {
4448 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004449 const ArrayType *array = split.Ty->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe();
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004450 if (!array) break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004451
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004452 type = array->getElementType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004453 qs.addConsistentQualifiers(split.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004454 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004455
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004456 return getQualifiedType(type, qs);
Anders Carlssone0808df2008-12-21 03:44:36 +00004457}
4458
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004459/// getConstantArrayElementCount - Returns number of constant array elements.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004460uint64_t
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004461ASTContext::getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType *CA) const {
4462 uint64_t ElementCount = 1;
4463 do {
4464 ElementCount *= CA->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Smith7808c6a2012-12-06 03:04:50 +00004465 CA = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantArrayType>(
4466 CA->getElementType()->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe());
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004467 } while (CA);
4468 return ElementCount;
4469}
4470
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004471/// getFloatingRank - Return a relative rank for floating point types.
4472/// This routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't a float.
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004473static FloatingRank getFloatingRank(QualType T) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004474 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004475 return getFloatingRank(CT->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004476
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004477 assert(T->getAs<BuiltinType>() && "getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
4478 switch (T->getAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004479 default: llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00004480 case BuiltinType::Half: return HalfRank;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004481 case BuiltinType::Float: return FloatRank;
4482 case BuiltinType::Double: return DoubleRank;
4483 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return LongDoubleRank;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004484 }
4485}
4486
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004487/// getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain - Returns a real floating
4488/// point or a complex type (based on typeDomain/typeSize).
Steve Narofffc6ffa22007-08-27 01:41:48 +00004489/// 'typeDomain' is a real floating point or complex type.
4490/// 'typeSize' is a real floating point or complex type.
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004491QualType ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain(QualType Size,
4492 QualType Domain) const {
4493 FloatingRank EltRank = getFloatingRank(Size);
4494 if (Domain->isComplexType()) {
4495 switch (EltRank) {
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004496 case HalfRank: llvm_unreachable("Complex half is not supported");
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004497 case FloatRank: return FloatComplexTy;
4498 case DoubleRank: return DoubleComplexTy;
4499 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleComplexTy;
4500 }
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004501 }
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004502
4503 assert(Domain->isRealFloatingType() && "Unknown domain!");
4504 switch (EltRank) {
Joey Goulydd7f4562013-01-23 11:56:20 +00004505 case HalfRank: return HalfTy;
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004506 case FloatRank: return FloatTy;
4507 case DoubleRank: return DoubleTy;
4508 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleTy;
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004509 }
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004510 llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): illegal value for rank");
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004511}
4512
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004513/// getFloatingTypeOrder - Compare the rank of the two specified floating
4514/// point types, ignoring the domain of the type (i.e. 'double' ==
4515/// '_Complex double'). If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004516/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004517int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004518 FloatingRank LHSR = getFloatingRank(LHS);
4519 FloatingRank RHSR = getFloatingRank(RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004520
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004521 if (LHSR == RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004522 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004523 if (LHSR > RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004524 return 1;
4525 return -1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004526}
4527
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004528/// getIntegerRank - Return an integer conversion rank (C99 6.3.1.1p1). This
4529/// routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't an integer or enum,
4530/// or if it is not canonicalized.
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004531unsigned ASTContext::getIntegerRank(const Type *T) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00004532 assert(T->isCanonicalUnqualified() && "T should be canonicalized");
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00004533
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004534 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004535 default: llvm_unreachable("getIntegerRank(): not a built-in integer");
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004536 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004537 return 1 + (getIntWidth(BoolTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004538 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
4539 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
4540 case BuiltinType::SChar:
4541 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004542 return 2 + (getIntWidth(CharTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004543 case BuiltinType::Short:
4544 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004545 return 3 + (getIntWidth(ShortTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004546 case BuiltinType::Int:
4547 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004548 return 4 + (getIntWidth(IntTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004549 case BuiltinType::Long:
4550 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004551 return 5 + (getIntWidth(LongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004552 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
4553 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004554 return 6 + (getIntWidth(LongLongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00004555 case BuiltinType::Int128:
4556 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
4557 return 7 + (getIntWidth(Int128Ty) << 3);
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004558 }
4559}
4560
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004561/// \brief Whether this is a promotable bitfield reference according
4562/// to C99 6.3.1.1p2, bullet 2 (and GCC extensions).
4563///
4564/// \returns the type this bit-field will promote to, or NULL if no
4565/// promotion occurs.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004566QualType ASTContext::isPromotableBitField(Expr *E) const {
Douglas Gregore05d3cb2010-05-24 20:13:53 +00004567 if (E->isTypeDependent() || E->isValueDependent())
4568 return QualType();
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00004569
4570 // FIXME: We should not do this unless E->refersToBitField() is true. This
4571 // matters in C where getSourceBitField() will find bit-fields for various
4572 // cases where the source expression is not a bit-field designator.
4573
John McCalld25db7e2013-05-06 21:39:12 +00004574 FieldDecl *Field = E->getSourceBitField(); // FIXME: conditional bit-fields?
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004575 if (!Field)
4576 return QualType();
4577
4578 QualType FT = Field->getType();
4579
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00004580 uint64_t BitWidth = Field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004581 uint64_t IntSize = getTypeSize(IntTy);
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00004582 // C++ [conv.prom]p5:
4583 // A prvalue for an integral bit-field can be converted to a prvalue of type
4584 // int if int can represent all the values of the bit-field; otherwise, it
4585 // can be converted to unsigned int if unsigned int can represent all the
4586 // values of the bit-field. If the bit-field is larger yet, no integral
4587 // promotion applies to it.
4588 // C11 6.3.1.1/2:
4589 // [For a bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int:]
4590 // If an int can represent all values of the original type (as restricted by
4591 // the width, for a bit-field), the value is converted to an int; otherwise,
4592 // it is converted to an unsigned int.
4593 //
4594 // FIXME: C does not permit promotion of a 'long : 3' bitfield to int.
4595 // We perform that promotion here to match GCC and C++.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004596 if (BitWidth < IntSize)
4597 return IntTy;
4598
4599 if (BitWidth == IntSize)
4600 return FT->isSignedIntegerType() ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4601
4602 // Types bigger than int are not subject to promotions, and therefore act
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00004603 // like the base type. GCC has some weird bugs in this area that we
4604 // deliberately do not follow (GCC follows a pre-standard resolution to
4605 // C's DR315 which treats bit-width as being part of the type, and this leaks
4606 // into their semantics in some cases).
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004607 return QualType();
4608}
4609
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004610/// getPromotedIntegerType - Returns the type that Promotable will
4611/// promote to: C99 6.3.1.1p2, assuming that Promotable is a promotable
4612/// integer type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004613QualType ASTContext::getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004614 assert(!Promotable.isNull());
4615 assert(Promotable->isPromotableIntegerType());
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00004616 if (const EnumType *ET = Promotable->getAs<EnumType>())
4617 return ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType();
Eli Friedman3f37c1c2011-10-26 07:22:48 +00004618
4619 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Promotable->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
4620 // C++ [conv.prom]: A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t
4621 // (3.9.1) can be converted to a prvalue of the first of the following
4622 // types that can represent all the values of its underlying type:
4623 // int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or
4624 // unsigned long long int [...]
4625 // FIXME: Is there some better way to compute this?
4626 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S ||
4627 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_U ||
4628 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char16 ||
4629 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char32) {
4630 bool FromIsSigned = BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S;
4631 uint64_t FromSize = getTypeSize(BT);
4632 QualType PromoteTypes[] = { IntTy, UnsignedIntTy, LongTy, UnsignedLongTy,
4633 LongLongTy, UnsignedLongLongTy };
4634 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < llvm::array_lengthof(PromoteTypes); ++Idx) {
4635 uint64_t ToSize = getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
4636 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
4637 (FromSize == ToSize &&
4638 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType()))
4639 return PromoteTypes[Idx];
4640 }
4641 llvm_unreachable("char type should fit into long long");
4642 }
4643 }
4644
4645 // At this point, we should have a signed or unsigned integer type.
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004646 if (Promotable->isSignedIntegerType())
4647 return IntTy;
Eli Friedman6745c3b2012-11-15 01:21:59 +00004648 uint64_t PromotableSize = getIntWidth(Promotable);
4649 uint64_t IntSize = getIntWidth(IntTy);
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004650 assert(Promotable->isUnsignedIntegerType() && PromotableSize <= IntSize);
4651 return (PromotableSize != IntSize) ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4652}
4653
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004654/// \brief Recurses in pointer/array types until it finds an objc retainable
4655/// type and returns its ownership.
4656Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ASTContext::getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const {
4657 while (!T.isNull()) {
4658 if (T.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None)
4659 return T.getObjCLifetime();
4660 if (T->isArrayType())
4661 T = getBaseElementType(T);
4662 else if (const PointerType *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>())
4663 T = PT->getPointeeType();
4664 else if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis8e252532011-07-01 23:01:46 +00004665 T = RT->getPointeeType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004666 else
4667 break;
4668 }
4669
4670 return Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4671}
4672
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004673static const Type *getIntegerTypeForEnum(const EnumType *ET) {
4674 // Incomplete enum types are not treated as integer types.
4675 // FIXME: In C++, enum types are never integer types.
4676 if (ET->getDecl()->isComplete() && !ET->getDecl()->isScoped())
4677 return ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004678 return nullptr;
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004679}
4680
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004681/// getIntegerTypeOrder - Returns the highest ranked integer type:
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004682/// C99 6.3.1.8p1. If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004683/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004684int ASTContext::getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004685 const Type *LHSC = getCanonicalType(LHS).getTypePtr();
4686 const Type *RHSC = getCanonicalType(RHS).getTypePtr();
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004687
4688 // Unwrap enums to their underlying type.
4689 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(LHSC))
4690 LHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4691 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(RHSC))
4692 RHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4693
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004694 if (LHSC == RHSC) return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004695
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004696 bool LHSUnsigned = LHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
4697 bool RHSUnsigned = RHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004698
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004699 unsigned LHSRank = getIntegerRank(LHSC);
4700 unsigned RHSRank = getIntegerRank(RHSC);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004701
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004702 if (LHSUnsigned == RHSUnsigned) { // Both signed or both unsigned.
4703 if (LHSRank == RHSRank) return 0;
4704 return LHSRank > RHSRank ? 1 : -1;
4705 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004706
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004707 // Otherwise, the LHS is signed and the RHS is unsigned or visa versa.
4708 if (LHSUnsigned) {
4709 // If the unsigned [LHS] type is larger, return it.
4710 if (LHSRank >= RHSRank)
4711 return 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004712
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004713 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4714 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004715 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004716 return -1;
4717 }
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004718
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004719 // If the unsigned [RHS] type is larger, return it.
4720 if (RHSRank >= LHSRank)
4721 return -1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004722
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004723 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4724 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004725 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004726 return 1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004727}
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004728
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004729// getCFConstantStringType - Return the type used for constant CFStrings.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004730QualType ASTContext::getCFConstantStringType() const {
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004731 if (!CFConstantStringTypeDecl) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004732 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("NSConstantString");
John McCallae580fe2010-02-05 01:33:36 +00004733 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->startDefinition();
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004734
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004735 QualType FieldTypes[4];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004736
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004737 // const int *isa;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004738 FieldTypes[0] = getPointerType(IntTy.withConst());
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004739 // int flags;
4740 FieldTypes[1] = IntTy;
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004741 // const char *str;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004742 FieldTypes[2] = getPointerType(CharTy.withConst());
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004743 // long length;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004744 FieldTypes[3] = LongTy;
4745
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004746 // Create fields
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004747 for (unsigned i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004748 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, CFConstantStringTypeDecl,
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +00004749 SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004750 SourceLocation(), nullptr,
4751 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4752 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Richard Smith938f40b2011-06-11 17:19:42 +00004753 /*Mutable=*/false,
Richard Smith2b013182012-06-10 03:12:00 +00004754 ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004755 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004756 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->addDecl(Field);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004757 }
4758
Douglas Gregord5058122010-02-11 01:19:42 +00004759 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->completeDefinition();
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004760 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004761
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004762 return getTagDeclType(CFConstantStringTypeDecl);
Gabor Greif412af032007-09-11 15:32:40 +00004763}
Anders Carlsson87c149b2007-10-11 01:00:40 +00004764
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00004765QualType ASTContext::getObjCSuperType() const {
4766 if (ObjCSuperType.isNull()) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004767 RecordDecl *ObjCSuperTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("objc_super");
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00004768 TUDecl->addDecl(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4769 ObjCSuperType = getTagDeclType(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4770 }
4771 return ObjCSuperType;
4772}
4773
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004774void ASTContext::setCFConstantStringType(QualType T) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004775 const RecordType *Rec = T->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004776 assert(Rec && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
4777 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = Rec->getDecl();
4778}
4779
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004780QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorType() const {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004781 if (BlockDescriptorType)
4782 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4783
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004784 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004785 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004786 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor");
4787 RD->startDefinition();
4788
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004789 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4790 UnsignedLongTy,
4791 UnsignedLongTy,
4792 };
4793
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00004794 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004795 "reserved",
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004796 "Size"
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004797 };
4798
4799 for (size_t i = 0; i < 2; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004800 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
4801 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004802 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4803 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004804 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004805 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004806 }
4807
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004808 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004809
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004810 BlockDescriptorType = RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004811
4812 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4813}
4814
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004815QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004816 if (BlockDescriptorExtendedType)
4817 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4818
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004819 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004820 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004821 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor_withcopydispose");
4822 RD->startDefinition();
4823
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004824 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4825 UnsignedLongTy,
4826 UnsignedLongTy,
4827 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy),
4828 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy)
4829 };
4830
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00004831 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004832 "reserved",
4833 "Size",
4834 "CopyFuncPtr",
4835 "DestroyFuncPtr"
4836 };
4837
4838 for (size_t i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004839 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
4840 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004841 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4842 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004843 /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004844 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004845 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004846 }
4847
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004848 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004849
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004850 BlockDescriptorExtendedType = RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004851 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4852}
4853
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00004854/// BlockRequiresCopying - Returns true if byref variable "D" of type "Ty"
4855/// requires copy/dispose. Note that this must match the logic
4856/// in buildByrefHelpers.
4857bool ASTContext::BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty,
4858 const VarDecl *D) {
4859 if (const CXXRecordDecl *record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
4860 const Expr *copyExpr = getBlockVarCopyInits(D);
4861 if (!copyExpr && record->hasTrivialDestructor()) return false;
4862
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00004863 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniana00076c2010-11-17 00:21:28 +00004864 }
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00004865
4866 if (!Ty->isObjCRetainableType()) return false;
4867
4868 Qualifiers qs = Ty.getQualifiers();
4869
4870 // If we have lifetime, that dominates.
4871 if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = qs.getObjCLifetime()) {
4872 assert(getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
4873
4874 switch (lifetime) {
4875 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("impossible");
4876
4877 // These are just bits as far as the runtime is concerned.
4878 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
4879 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
4880 return false;
4881
4882 // Tell the runtime that this is ARC __weak, called by the
4883 // byref routines.
4884 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
4885 // ARC __strong __block variables need to be retained.
4886 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
4887 return true;
4888 }
4889 llvm_unreachable("fell out of lifetime switch!");
4890 }
4891 return (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || isObjCNSObjectType(Ty) ||
4892 Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType());
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00004893}
4894
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00004895bool ASTContext::getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty,
4896 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime &LifeTime,
4897 bool &HasByrefExtendedLayout) const {
4898
4899 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1 ||
4900 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
4901 return false;
4902
4903 HasByrefExtendedLayout = false;
Fariborz Jahanianf762b722012-12-11 19:58:01 +00004904 if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00004905 HasByrefExtendedLayout = true;
4906 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4907 }
4908 else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
4909 LifeTime = Ty.getObjCLifetime();
4910 // MRR.
4911 else if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
4912 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
4913 else
4914 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4915 return true;
4916}
4917
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00004918TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCInstanceTypeDecl() {
4919 if (!ObjCInstanceTypeDecl)
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00004920 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl =
4921 buildImplicitTypedef(getObjCIdType(), "instancetype");
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00004922 return ObjCInstanceTypeDecl;
4923}
4924
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00004925// This returns true if a type has been typedefed to BOOL:
4926// typedef <type> BOOL;
Chris Lattnere0218992007-10-30 20:27:44 +00004927static bool isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T) {
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00004928 if (const TypedefType *TT = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T))
Chris Lattner9b1f2792008-11-24 03:52:59 +00004929 if (IdentifierInfo *II = TT->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
4930 return II->isStr("BOOL");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004931
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00004932 return false;
4933}
4934
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00004935/// getObjCEncodingTypeSize returns size of type for objective-c encoding
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004936/// purpose.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004937CharUnits ASTContext::getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const {
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004938 if (!type->isIncompleteArrayType() && type->isIncompleteType())
4939 return CharUnits::Zero();
4940
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004941 CharUnits sz = getTypeSizeInChars(type);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004942
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004943 // Make all integer and enum types at least as large as an int
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004944 if (sz.isPositive() && type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004945 sz = std::max(sz, getTypeSizeInChars(IntTy));
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004946 // Treat arrays as pointers, since that's how they're passed in.
4947 else if (type->isArrayType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004948 sz = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004949 return sz;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004950}
4951
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00004952bool ASTContext::isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(const VarDecl *VD) const {
4953 return getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
4954 VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
Alexey Bataev15413ea2015-05-20 11:57:02 +00004955 VD->isFirstDecl() && !VD->isOutOfLine() && VD->hasInit();
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00004956}
4957
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004958static inline
4959std::string charUnitsToString(const CharUnits &CU) {
4960 return llvm::itostr(CU.getQuantity());
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004961}
4962
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004963/// getObjCEncodingForBlock - Return the encoded type for this block
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004964/// declaration.
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004965std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr *Expr) const {
4966 std::string S;
4967
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004968 const BlockDecl *Decl = Expr->getBlockDecl();
4969 QualType BlockTy =
4970 Expr->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4971 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00004972 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004973 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(
4974 Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S,
4975 true /*Extended*/);
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00004976 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004977 getObjCEncodingForType(BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004978 // Compute size of all parameters.
4979 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
4980 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
4981 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004982 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
4983 CharUnits ParmOffset = PtrSize;
Aaron Ballmanb2b8b1d2014-03-07 16:09:59 +00004984 for (auto PI : Decl->params()) {
4985 QualType PType = PI->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004986 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahaniand4879412012-06-30 00:48:59 +00004987 if (sz.isZero())
4988 continue;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004989 assert (sz.isPositive() && "BlockExpr - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004990 ParmOffset += sz;
4991 }
4992 // Size of the argument frame
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004993 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004994 // Block pointer and offset.
4995 S += "@?0";
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004996
4997 // Argument types.
4998 ParmOffset = PtrSize;
Aaron Ballmanb2b8b1d2014-03-07 16:09:59 +00004999 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) {
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005000 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
5001 if (const ArrayType *AT =
5002 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5003 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5004 // elements.
5005 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5006 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5007 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5008 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00005009 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00005010 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, PType,
5011 S, true /*Extended*/);
5012 else
5013 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005014 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005015 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005016 }
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00005017
5018 return S;
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005019}
5020
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005021bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *Decl,
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005022 std::string& S) {
5023 // Encode result type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005024 getObjCEncodingForType(Decl->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005025 CharUnits ParmOffset;
5026 // Compute size of all parameters.
Aaron Ballmanf6bf62e2014-03-07 15:12:56 +00005027 for (auto PI : Decl->params()) {
5028 QualType PType = PI->getType();
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005029 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005030 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00005031 continue;
5032
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005033 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005034 "getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005035 ParmOffset += sz;
5036 }
5037 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5038 ParmOffset = CharUnits::Zero();
5039
5040 // Argument types.
Aaron Ballmanf6bf62e2014-03-07 15:12:56 +00005041 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) {
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005042 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
5043 if (const ArrayType *AT =
5044 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5045 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5046 // elements.
5047 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5048 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5049 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5050 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5051 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
5052 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5053 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
5054 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005055
5056 return false;
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005057}
5058
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005059/// getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter - Return the encoded type for a single
5060/// method parameter or return type. If Extended, include class names and
5061/// block object types.
5062void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
5063 QualType T, std::string& S,
5064 bool Extended) const {
5065 // Encode type qualifer, 'in', 'inout', etc. for the parameter.
5066 getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(QT, S);
5067 // Encode parameter type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005068 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005069 true /*OutermostType*/,
5070 false /*EncodingProperty*/,
5071 false /*StructField*/,
5072 Extended /*EncodeBlockParameters*/,
5073 Extended /*EncodeClassNames*/);
5074}
5075
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00005076/// getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Return the encoded type for this method
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005077/// declaration.
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005078bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl *Decl,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005079 std::string& S,
5080 bool Extended) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005081 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005082 // Encode return type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005083 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
5084 Decl->getReturnType(), S, Extended);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005085 // Compute size of all parameters.
5086 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
5087 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
5088 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005089 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005090 // The first two arguments (self and _cmd) are pointers; account for
5091 // their size.
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005092 CharUnits ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00005093 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00005094 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Chris Lattnera4997152009-02-20 18:43:26 +00005095 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005096 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005097 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00005098 continue;
5099
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005100 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
5101 "getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Incomplete param type");
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005102 ParmOffset += sz;
5103 }
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005104 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005105 S += "@0:";
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005106 S += charUnitsToString(PtrSize);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005107
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005108 // Argument types.
5109 ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00005110 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00005111 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00005112 const ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005113 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
Fariborz Jahaniana0befc02008-12-20 23:29:59 +00005114 if (const ArrayType *AT =
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00005115 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5116 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5117 // elements.
Steve Naroff323827e2009-04-14 00:40:09 +00005118 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00005119 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5120 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5121 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005122 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(PVDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
5123 PType, S, Extended);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005124 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005125 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005126 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005127
5128 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005129}
5130
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005131ObjCPropertyImplDecl *
5132ASTContext::getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(
5133 const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
5134 const Decl *Container) const {
5135 if (!Container)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005136 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005137 if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CID =
5138 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(Container)) {
Aaron Ballmand85eff42014-03-14 15:02:45 +00005139 for (auto *PID : CID->property_impls())
5140 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
5141 return PID;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005142 } else {
5143 const ObjCImplementationDecl *OID=cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(Container);
5144 for (auto *PID : OID->property_impls())
5145 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
5146 return PID;
5147 }
5148 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005149}
5150
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005151/// getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl - Return the encoded type for this
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00005152/// property declaration. If non-NULL, Container must be either an
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005153/// ObjCCategoryImplDecl or ObjCImplementationDecl; it should only be
5154/// NULL when getting encodings for protocol properties.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005155/// Property attributes are stored as a comma-delimited C string. The simple
5156/// attributes readonly and bycopy are encoded as single characters. The
5157/// parametrized attributes, getter=name, setter=name, and ivar=name, are
5158/// encoded as single characters, followed by an identifier. Property types
5159/// are also encoded as a parametrized attribute. The characters used to encode
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00005160/// these attributes are defined by the following enumeration:
5161/// @code
5162/// enum PropertyAttributes {
5163/// kPropertyReadOnly = 'R', // property is read-only.
5164/// kPropertyBycopy = 'C', // property is a copy of the value last assigned
5165/// kPropertyByref = '&', // property is a reference to the value last assigned
5166/// kPropertyDynamic = 'D', // property is dynamic
5167/// kPropertyGetter = 'G', // followed by getter selector name
5168/// kPropertySetter = 'S', // followed by setter selector name
5169/// kPropertyInstanceVariable = 'V' // followed by instance variable name
Bob Wilson8cf61852012-03-22 17:48:02 +00005170/// kPropertyType = 'T' // followed by old-style type encoding.
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00005171/// kPropertyWeak = 'W' // 'weak' property
5172/// kPropertyStrong = 'P' // property GC'able
5173/// kPropertyNonAtomic = 'N' // property non-atomic
5174/// };
5175/// @endcode
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005176void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005177 const Decl *Container,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005178 std::string& S) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005179 // Collect information from the property implementation decl(s).
5180 bool Dynamic = false;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005181 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *SynthesizePID = nullptr;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005182
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005183 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropertyImpDecl =
5184 getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(PD, Container)) {
5185 if (PropertyImpDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
5186 Dynamic = true;
5187 else
5188 SynthesizePID = PropertyImpDecl;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005189 }
5190
5191 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
5192 S = "T";
5193
5194 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005195 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5196 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00005197 getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(PD->getType(), S);
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005198
5199 if (PD->isReadOnly()) {
5200 S += ",R";
Nico Weber4e8626f2013-05-08 23:47:40 +00005201 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_copy)
5202 S += ",C";
5203 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_retain)
5204 S += ",&";
Fariborz Jahanian33079ee2014-04-02 22:49:42 +00005205 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_weak)
5206 S += ",W";
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005207 } else {
5208 switch (PD->getSetterKind()) {
5209 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Assign: break;
5210 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Copy: S += ",C"; break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005211 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Retain: S += ",&"; break;
Fariborz Jahanian70a315c2011-08-12 20:47:08 +00005212 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Weak: S += ",W"; break;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005213 }
5214 }
5215
5216 // It really isn't clear at all what this means, since properties
5217 // are "dynamic by default".
5218 if (Dynamic)
5219 S += ",D";
5220
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005221 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_nonatomic)
5222 S += ",N";
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005223
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005224 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_getter) {
5225 S += ",G";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005226 S += PD->getGetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005227 }
5228
5229 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_setter) {
5230 S += ",S";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005231 S += PD->getSetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005232 }
5233
5234 if (SynthesizePID) {
5235 const ObjCIvarDecl *OID = SynthesizePID->getPropertyIvarDecl();
5236 S += ",V";
Chris Lattner1cbaacc2008-11-24 04:00:27 +00005237 S += OID->getNameAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005238 }
5239
5240 // FIXME: OBJCGC: weak & strong
5241}
5242
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005243/// getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding -
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005244/// Another legacy compatibility encoding: 32-bit longs are encoded as
5245/// 'l' or 'L' , but not always. For typedefs, we need to use
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005246/// 'i' or 'I' instead if encoding a struct field, or a pointer!
5247///
5248void ASTContext::getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding (QualType &PointeeTy) const {
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005249 if (isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005250 if (const BuiltinType *BT = PointeeTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005251 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005252 PointeeTy = UnsignedIntTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005253 else
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005254 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005255 PointeeTy = IntTy;
5256 }
5257 }
5258}
5259
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005260void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T, std::string& S,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005261 const FieldDecl *Field,
5262 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005263 // We follow the behavior of gcc, expanding structures which are
5264 // directly pointed to, and expanding embedded structures. Note that
5265 // these rules are sufficient to prevent recursive encoding of the
5266 // same type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005267 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, Field,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005268 true /* outermost type */, false, false,
5269 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005270}
5271
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00005272void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(QualType T,
5273 std::string& S) const {
5274 // Encode result type.
5275 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5276 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
5277 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
5278 true /* outermost type */,
5279 true /* encoding property */);
5280}
5281
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005282static char getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(const ASTContext *C,
5283 BuiltinType::Kind kind) {
5284 switch (kind) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005285 case BuiltinType::Void: return 'v';
5286 case BuiltinType::Bool: return 'B';
5287 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
5288 case BuiltinType::UChar: return 'C';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005289 case BuiltinType::Char16:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005290 case BuiltinType::UShort: return 'S';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005291 case BuiltinType::Char32:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005292 case BuiltinType::UInt: return 'I';
5293 case BuiltinType::ULong:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005294 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'L' : 'Q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005295 case BuiltinType::UInt128: return 'T';
5296 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: return 'Q';
5297 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
5298 case BuiltinType::SChar: return 'c';
5299 case BuiltinType::Short: return 's';
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00005300 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
5301 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005302 case BuiltinType::Int: return 'i';
5303 case BuiltinType::Long:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005304 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'l' : 'q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005305 case BuiltinType::LongLong: return 'q';
5306 case BuiltinType::Int128: return 't';
5307 case BuiltinType::Float: return 'f';
5308 case BuiltinType::Double: return 'd';
Daniel Dunbar7cba5a72010-10-11 21:13:48 +00005309 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return 'D';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005310 case BuiltinType::NullPtr: return '*'; // like char*
5311
5312 case BuiltinType::Half:
5313 // FIXME: potentially need @encodes for these!
5314 return ' ';
5315
5316 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
5317 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
5318 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
5319 llvm_unreachable("@encoding ObjC primitive type");
5320
5321 // OpenCL and placeholder types don't need @encodings.
5322 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
5323 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
5324 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
5325 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
5326 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
5327 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00005328 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00005329 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005330 case BuiltinType::Dependent:
5331#define BUILTIN_TYPE(KIND, ID)
5332#define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(KIND, ID) \
5333 case BuiltinType::KIND:
5334#include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
5335 llvm_unreachable("invalid builtin type for @encode");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005336 }
David Blaikie5a6a0202013-01-09 17:48:41 +00005337 llvm_unreachable("invalid BuiltinType::Kind value");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005338}
5339
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005340static char ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext *C, const EnumType *ET) {
5341 EnumDecl *Enum = ET->getDecl();
5342
5343 // The encoding of an non-fixed enum type is always 'i', regardless of size.
5344 if (!Enum->isFixed())
5345 return 'i';
5346
5347 // The encoding of a fixed enum type matches its fixed underlying type.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005348 const BuiltinType *BT = Enum->getIntegerType()->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5349 return getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(C, BT->getKind());
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005350}
5351
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005352static void EncodeBitField(const ASTContext *Ctx, std::string& S,
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005353 QualType T, const FieldDecl *FD) {
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005354 assert(FD->isBitField() && "not a bitfield - getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl");
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005355 S += 'b';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005356 // The NeXT runtime encodes bit fields as b followed by the number of bits.
5357 // The GNU runtime requires more information; bitfields are encoded as b,
5358 // then the offset (in bits) of the first element, then the type of the
5359 // bitfield, then the size in bits. For example, in this structure:
5360 //
5361 // struct
5362 // {
5363 // int integer;
5364 // int flags:2;
5365 // };
5366 // On a 32-bit system, the encoding for flags would be b2 for the NeXT
5367 // runtime, but b32i2 for the GNU runtime. The reason for this extra
5368 // information is not especially sensible, but we're stuck with it for
5369 // compatibility with GCC, although providing it breaks anything that
5370 // actually uses runtime introspection and wants to work on both runtimes...
John McCall5fb5df92012-06-20 06:18:46 +00005371 if (Ctx->getLangOpts().ObjCRuntime.isGNUFamily()) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005372 const RecordDecl *RD = FD->getParent();
5373 const ASTRecordLayout &RL = Ctx->getASTRecordLayout(RD);
Eli Friedmana3c122d2011-07-07 01:54:01 +00005374 S += llvm::utostr(RL.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex()));
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005375 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
5376 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(Ctx, ET);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005377 else {
5378 const BuiltinType *BT = T->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5379 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(Ctx, BT->getKind());
5380 }
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005381 }
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005382 S += llvm::utostr(FD->getBitWidthValue(*Ctx));
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005383}
5384
Daniel Dunbar07d07852009-10-18 21:17:35 +00005385// FIXME: Use SmallString for accumulating string.
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005386void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T, std::string& S,
5387 bool ExpandPointedToStructures,
5388 bool ExpandStructures,
Daniel Dunbarc040ce42009-04-20 06:37:24 +00005389 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005390 bool OutermostType,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005391 bool EncodingProperty,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005392 bool StructField,
5393 bool EncodeBlockParameters,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005394 bool EncodeClassNames,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005395 bool EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
5396 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005397 CanQualType CT = getCanonicalType(T);
5398 switch (CT->getTypeClass()) {
5399 case Type::Builtin:
5400 case Type::Enum:
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005401 if (FD && FD->isBitField())
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005402 return EncodeBitField(this, S, T, FD);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005403 if (const BuiltinType *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CT))
5404 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(this, BT->getKind());
5405 else
5406 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(this, cast<EnumType>(CT));
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005407 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005408
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005409 case Type::Complex: {
5410 const ComplexType *CT = T->castAs<ComplexType>();
Anders Carlsson39b2e132009-04-09 21:55:45 +00005411 S += 'j';
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005412 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(CT->getElementType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005413 return;
5414 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005415
5416 case Type::Atomic: {
5417 const AtomicType *AT = T->castAs<AtomicType>();
5418 S += 'A';
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005419 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getValueType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005420 return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ffd7062010-04-13 23:45:47 +00005421 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005422
5423 // encoding for pointer or reference types.
5424 case Type::Pointer:
5425 case Type::LValueReference:
5426 case Type::RValueReference: {
5427 QualType PointeeTy;
5428 if (isa<PointerType>(CT)) {
5429 const PointerType *PT = T->castAs<PointerType>();
5430 if (PT->isObjCSelType()) {
5431 S += ':';
5432 return;
5433 }
5434 PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType();
5435 } else {
5436 PointeeTy = T->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
5437 }
5438
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005439 bool isReadOnly = false;
5440 // For historical/compatibility reasons, the read-only qualifier of the
5441 // pointee gets emitted _before_ the '^'. The read-only qualifier of
5442 // the pointer itself gets ignored, _unless_ we are looking at a typedef!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005443 // Also, do not emit the 'r' for anything but the outermost type!
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005444 if (isa<TypedefType>(T.getTypePtr())) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005445 if (OutermostType && T.isConstQualified()) {
5446 isReadOnly = true;
5447 S += 'r';
5448 }
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00005449 } else if (OutermostType) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005450 QualType P = PointeeTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005451 while (P->getAs<PointerType>())
5452 P = P->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005453 if (P.isConstQualified()) {
5454 isReadOnly = true;
5455 S += 'r';
5456 }
5457 }
5458 if (isReadOnly) {
5459 // Another legacy compatibility encoding. Some ObjC qualifier and type
5460 // combinations need to be rearranged.
5461 // Rewrite "in const" from "nr" to "rn"
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00005462 if (StringRef(S).endswith("nr"))
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00005463 S.replace(S.end()-2, S.end(), "rn");
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005464 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005465
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005466 if (PointeeTy->isCharType()) {
5467 // char pointer types should be encoded as '*' unless it is a
5468 // type that has been typedef'd to 'BOOL'.
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005469 if (!isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(PointeeTy)) {
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005470 S += '*';
5471 return;
5472 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005473 } else if (const RecordType *RTy = PointeeTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Steve Naroff3de6b702009-07-22 17:14:51 +00005474 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_class *" to "#".
5475 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_class")) {
5476 S += '#';
5477 return;
5478 }
5479 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_object *" to "@".
5480 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_object")) {
5481 S += '@';
5482 return;
5483 }
5484 // fall through...
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005485 }
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005486 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005487 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(PointeeTy);
5488
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005489 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005490 nullptr, false, false, false, false, false, false,
5491 NotEncodedT);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005492 return;
5493 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005494
5495 case Type::ConstantArray:
5496 case Type::IncompleteArray:
5497 case Type::VariableArray: {
5498 const ArrayType *AT = cast<ArrayType>(CT);
5499
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005500 if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT) && !StructField) {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005501 // Incomplete arrays are encoded as a pointer to the array element.
5502 S += '^';
5503
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005504 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005505 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
5506 } else {
5507 S += '[';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005508
Fariborz Jahanianf0dc11a2013-06-04 16:04:37 +00005509 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5510 S += llvm::utostr(CAT->getSize().getZExtValue());
5511 else {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005512 //Variable length arrays are encoded as a regular array with 0 elements.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005513 assert((isa<VariableArrayType>(AT) || isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) &&
5514 "Unknown array type!");
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005515 S += '0';
5516 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005517
5518 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005519 false, ExpandStructures, FD,
5520 false, false, false, false, false, false,
5521 NotEncodedT);
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005522 S += ']';
5523 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005524 return;
5525 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005526
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005527 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
5528 case Type::FunctionProto:
Anders Carlssondf4cc612007-10-30 00:06:20 +00005529 S += '?';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005530 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005531
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005532 case Type::Record: {
5533 RecordDecl *RDecl = cast<RecordType>(CT)->getDecl();
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005534 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? '(' : '{';
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005535 // Anonymous structures print as '?'
5536 if (const IdentifierInfo *II = RDecl->getIdentifier()) {
5537 S += II->getName();
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005538 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
5539 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RDecl)) {
5540 const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Benjamin Kramer9170e912013-02-22 15:46:01 +00005541 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(S);
5542 TemplateSpecializationType::PrintTemplateArgumentList(OS,
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00005543 TemplateArgs.data(),
5544 TemplateArgs.size(),
Douglas Gregorc0b07282011-09-27 22:38:19 +00005545 (*this).getPrintingPolicy());
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005546 }
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005547 } else {
5548 S += '?';
5549 }
Daniel Dunbarfc1066d2008-10-17 20:21:44 +00005550 if (ExpandStructures) {
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005551 S += '=';
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005552 if (!RDecl->isUnion()) {
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005553 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RDecl, S, FD, true, NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005554 } else {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00005555 for (const auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005556 if (FD) {
5557 S += '"';
5558 S += Field->getNameAsString();
5559 S += '"';
5560 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005561
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005562 // Special case bit-fields.
5563 if (Field->isBitField()) {
5564 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true,
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00005565 Field);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005566 } else {
5567 QualType qt = Field->getType();
5568 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5569 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true,
5570 FD, /*OutermostType*/false,
5571 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005572 /*StructField*/true,
5573 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005574 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005575 }
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005576 }
Fariborz Jahanianbc92fd72007-11-13 23:21:38 +00005577 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005578 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? ')' : '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005579 return;
5580 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005581
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005582 case Type::BlockPointer: {
5583 const BlockPointerType *BT = T->castAs<BlockPointerType>();
Steve Naroff49140cb2009-02-02 18:24:29 +00005584 S += "@?"; // Unlike a pointer-to-function, which is "^?".
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005585 if (EncodeBlockParameters) {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005586 const FunctionType *FT = BT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005587
5588 S += '<';
5589 // Block return type
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005590 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
5591 FT->getReturnType(), S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures,
5592 FD, false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005593 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames, false,
5594 NotEncodedT);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005595 // Block self
5596 S += "@?";
5597 // Block parameters
5598 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
Aaron Ballman40bd0aa2014-03-17 15:23:01 +00005599 for (const auto &I : FPT->param_types())
5600 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
5601 I, S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures, FD,
5602 false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005603 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames,
5604 false, NotEncodedT);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005605 }
5606 S += '>';
5607 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005608 return;
5609 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005610
Fariborz Jahanian33fa9622014-01-28 20:41:15 +00005611 case Type::ObjCObject: {
5612 // hack to match legacy encoding of *id and *Class
5613 QualType Ty = getObjCObjectPointerType(CT);
5614 if (Ty->isObjCIdType()) {
5615 S += "{objc_object=}";
5616 return;
5617 }
5618 else if (Ty->isObjCClassType()) {
5619 S += "{objc_class=}";
5620 return;
5621 }
5622 }
5623
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005624 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
5625 // Ignore protocol qualifiers when mangling at this level.
5626 T = T->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getBaseType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005627
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005628 // The assumption seems to be that this assert will succeed
5629 // because nested levels will have filtered out 'id' and 'Class'.
5630 const ObjCInterfaceType *OIT = T->castAs<ObjCInterfaceType>();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005631 // @encode(class_name)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005632 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OIT->getDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005633 S += '{';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00005634 S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005635 S += '=';
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005636 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005637 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5638 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005639 const FieldDecl *Field = cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]);
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005640 if (Field->isBitField())
5641 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, Field);
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005642 else
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005643 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, FD,
5644 false, false, false, false, false,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005645 EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
5646 NotEncodedT);
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005647 }
5648 S += '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005649 return;
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005650 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005651
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005652 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
5653 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = T->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005654 if (OPT->isObjCIdType()) {
5655 S += '@';
5656 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005657 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005658
Steve Narofff0c86112009-10-28 22:03:49 +00005659 if (OPT->isObjCClassType() || OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) {
5660 // FIXME: Consider if we need to output qualifiers for 'Class<p>'.
5661 // Since this is a binary compatibility issue, need to consult with runtime
5662 // folks. Fortunately, this is a *very* obsure construct.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005663 S += '#';
5664 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005665 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005666
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005667 if (OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005668 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(getObjCIdType(), S,
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005669 ExpandPointedToStructures,
5670 ExpandStructures, FD);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005671 if (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005672 // Note that we do extended encoding of protocol qualifer list
5673 // Only when doing ivar or property encoding.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005674 S += '"';
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005675 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005676 S += '<';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00005677 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005678 S += '>';
5679 }
5680 S += '"';
5681 }
5682 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005683 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005684
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005685 QualType PointeeTy = OPT->getPointeeType();
5686 if (!EncodingProperty &&
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005687 isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr()) &&
5688 !EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005689 // Another historical/compatibility reason.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005690 // We encode the underlying type which comes out as
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005691 // {...};
5692 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005693 if (FD && OPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc682ef52013-07-12 16:41:56 +00005694 // Prevent recursive encoding of fields in some rare cases.
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005695 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OPT->getInterfaceDecl();
5696 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
5697 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5698 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
5699 if (cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]) == FD) {
5700 S += '{';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00005701 S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005702 S += '}';
5703 return;
5704 }
5705 }
5706 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005707 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S,
5708 false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005709 nullptr,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005710 false, false, false, false, false,
5711 /*EncodePointerToObjCTypedef*/true);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005712 return;
5713 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005714
5715 S += '@';
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005716 if (OPT->getInterfaceDecl() &&
5717 (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames)) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005718 S += '"';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00005719 S += OPT->getInterfaceDecl()->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005720 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005721 S += '<';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00005722 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005723 S += '>';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005724 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005725 S += '"';
5726 }
5727 return;
5728 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005729
John McCalla9e6e8d2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00005730 // gcc just blithely ignores member pointers.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005731 // FIXME: we shoul do better than that. 'M' is available.
5732 case Type::MemberPointer:
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005733 // This matches gcc's encoding, even though technically it is insufficient.
5734 //FIXME. We should do a better job than gcc.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005735 case Type::Vector:
5736 case Type::ExtVector:
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005737 // Until we have a coherent encoding of these three types, issue warning.
5738 { if (NotEncodedT)
5739 *NotEncodedT = T;
5740 return;
5741 }
5742
5743 // We could see an undeduced auto type here during error recovery.
5744 // Just ignore it.
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00005745 case Type::Auto:
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00005746 return;
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005747
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00005748
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005749#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5750#define TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5751#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5752 case Type::KIND:
5753#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5754 case Type::KIND:
5755#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5756 case Type::KIND:
5757#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
5758 llvm_unreachable("@encode for dependent type!");
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005759 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005760 llvm_unreachable("bad type kind!");
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005761}
5762
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005763void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl *RDecl,
5764 std::string &S,
5765 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005766 bool includeVBases,
5767 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005768 assert(RDecl && "Expected non-null RecordDecl");
5769 assert(!RDecl->isUnion() && "Should not be called for unions");
5770 if (!RDecl->getDefinition())
5771 return;
5772
5773 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRec = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RDecl);
5774 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *> FieldOrBaseOffsets;
5775 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RDecl);
5776
5777 if (CXXRec) {
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +00005778 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->bases()) {
5779 if (!BI.isVirtual()) {
5780 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005781 if (base->isEmpty())
5782 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00005783 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getBaseClassOffset(base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005784 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5785 std::make_pair(offs, base));
5786 }
5787 }
5788 }
5789
5790 unsigned i = 0;
Hans Wennborga302cd92014-08-21 16:06:57 +00005791 for (auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005792 uint64_t offs = layout.getFieldOffset(i);
5793 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
Hans Wennborga302cd92014-08-21 16:06:57 +00005794 std::make_pair(offs, Field));
5795 ++i;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005796 }
5797
5798 if (CXXRec && includeVBases) {
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +00005799 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->vbases()) {
5800 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005801 if (base->isEmpty())
5802 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00005803 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getVBaseClassOffset(base));
Eli Friedman1d24af82013-09-18 01:59:16 +00005804 if (offs >= uint64_t(toBits(layout.getNonVirtualSize())) &&
5805 FieldOrBaseOffsets.find(offs) == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis81c0b5c2011-09-26 18:14:24 +00005806 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(),
5807 std::make_pair(offs, base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005808 }
5809 }
5810
5811 CharUnits size;
5812 if (CXXRec) {
5813 size = includeVBases ? layout.getSize() : layout.getNonVirtualSize();
5814 } else {
5815 size = layout.getSize();
5816 }
5817
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005818#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005819 uint64_t CurOffs = 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005820#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005821 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *>::iterator
5822 CurLayObj = FieldOrBaseOffsets.begin();
5823
Douglas Gregorf5d6c742012-04-27 22:30:01 +00005824 if (CXXRec && CXXRec->isDynamicClass() &&
5825 (CurLayObj == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end() || CurLayObj->first != 0)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005826 if (FD) {
5827 S += "\"_vptr$";
5828 std::string recname = CXXRec->getNameAsString();
5829 if (recname.empty()) recname = "?";
5830 S += recname;
5831 S += '"';
5832 }
5833 S += "^^?";
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005834#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005835 CurOffs += getTypeSize(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005836#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005837 }
5838
5839 if (!RDecl->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
5840 // Mark the end of the structure.
5841 uint64_t offs = toBits(size);
5842 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005843 std::make_pair(offs, nullptr));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005844 }
5845
5846 for (; CurLayObj != FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(); ++CurLayObj) {
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005847#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005848 assert(CurOffs <= CurLayObj->first);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005849 if (CurOffs < CurLayObj->first) {
5850 uint64_t padding = CurLayObj->first - CurOffs;
5851 // FIXME: There doesn't seem to be a way to indicate in the encoding that
5852 // packing/alignment of members is different that normal, in which case
5853 // the encoding will be out-of-sync with the real layout.
5854 // If the runtime switches to just consider the size of types without
5855 // taking into account alignment, we could make padding explicit in the
5856 // encoding (e.g. using arrays of chars). The encoding strings would be
5857 // longer then though.
5858 CurOffs += padding;
5859 }
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005860#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005861
5862 NamedDecl *dcl = CurLayObj->second;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005863 if (!dcl)
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005864 break; // reached end of structure.
5865
5866 if (CXXRecordDecl *base = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(dcl)) {
5867 // We expand the bases without their virtual bases since those are going
5868 // in the initial structure. Note that this differs from gcc which
5869 // expands virtual bases each time one is encountered in the hierarchy,
5870 // making the encoding type bigger than it really is.
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005871 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(base, S, FD, /*includeVBases*/false,
5872 NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005873 assert(!base->isEmpty());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005874#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005875 CurOffs += toBits(getASTRecordLayout(base).getNonVirtualSize());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005876#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005877 } else {
5878 FieldDecl *field = cast<FieldDecl>(dcl);
5879 if (FD) {
5880 S += '"';
5881 S += field->getNameAsString();
5882 S += '"';
5883 }
5884
5885 if (field->isBitField()) {
5886 EncodeBitField(this, S, field->getType(), field);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005887#ifndef NDEBUG
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005888 CurOffs += field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005889#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005890 } else {
5891 QualType qt = field->getType();
5892 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5893 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true, FD,
5894 /*OutermostType*/false,
5895 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005896 /*StructField*/true,
5897 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005898#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005899 CurOffs += getTypeSize(field->getType());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005900#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005901 }
5902 }
5903 }
5904}
5905
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005906void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
Fariborz Jahanianac73ff82007-11-01 17:18:37 +00005907 std::string& S) const {
5908 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In)
5909 S += 'n';
5910 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout)
5911 S += 'N';
5912 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out)
5913 S += 'o';
5914 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy)
5915 S += 'O';
5916 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref)
5917 S += 'R';
5918 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway)
5919 S += 'V';
5920}
5921
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005922TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCIdDecl() const {
5923 if (!ObjCIdDecl) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005924 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, nullptr, 0);
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005925 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005926 ObjCIdDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "id");
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005927 }
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005928 return ObjCIdDecl;
Steve Naroff66e9f332007-10-15 14:41:52 +00005929}
5930
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00005931TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCSelDecl() const {
5932 if (!ObjCSelDecl) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005933 QualType T = getPointerType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy);
5934 ObjCSelDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "SEL");
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00005935 }
5936 return ObjCSelDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian4bef4622007-10-16 20:40:23 +00005937}
5938
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005939TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCClassDecl() const {
5940 if (!ObjCClassDecl) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005941 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, nullptr, 0);
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005942 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005943 ObjCClassDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "Class");
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005944 }
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005945 return ObjCClassDecl;
Anders Carlssonf56a7ae2007-10-31 02:53:19 +00005946}
5947
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00005948ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjCProtocolDecl() const {
5949 if (!ObjCProtocolClassDecl) {
5950 ObjCProtocolClassDecl
5951 = ObjCInterfaceDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5952 SourceLocation(),
5953 &Idents.get("Protocol"),
Douglas Gregor85f3f952015-07-07 03:57:15 +00005954 /*typeParamList=*/nullptr,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005955 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr,
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00005956 SourceLocation(), true);
5957 }
5958
5959 return ObjCProtocolClassDecl;
5960}
5961
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005962//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5963// __builtin_va_list Construction Functions
5964//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5965
5966static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5967 // typedef char* __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005968 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->CharTy);
5969 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005970}
5971
5972static TypedefDecl *CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5973 // typedef void* __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005974 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5975 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005976}
5977
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005978static TypedefDecl *
5979CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005980 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005981 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005982 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5983 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
5984 NamespaceDecl *NS;
5985 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5986 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005987 /*Inline*/ false, SourceLocation(),
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005988 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005989 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005990 NS->setImplicit();
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005991 VaListTagDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005992 }
5993
5994 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5995
5996 const size_t NumFields = 5;
5997 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5998 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5999
6000 // void *__stack;
6001 FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6002 FieldNames[0] = "__stack";
6003
6004 // void *__gr_top;
6005 FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6006 FieldNames[1] = "__gr_top";
6007
6008 // void *__vr_top;
6009 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6010 FieldNames[2] = "__vr_top";
6011
6012 // int __gr_offs;
6013 FieldTypes[3] = Context->IntTy;
6014 FieldNames[3] = "__gr_offs";
6015
6016 // int __vr_offs;
6017 FieldTypes[4] = Context->IntTy;
6018 FieldNames[4] = "__vr_offs";
6019
6020 // Create fields
6021 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6022 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6023 VaListTagDecl,
6024 SourceLocation(),
6025 SourceLocation(),
6026 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006027 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6028 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006029 /*Mutable=*/false,
6030 ICIS_NoInit);
6031 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6032 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6033 }
6034 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6035 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6036 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
6037
6038 // } __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006039 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__builtin_va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006040}
6041
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006042static TypedefDecl *CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6043 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6044 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
6045
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006046 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006047 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6048
6049 const size_t NumFields = 5;
6050 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6051 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6052
6053 // unsigned char gpr;
6054 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
6055 FieldNames[0] = "gpr";
6056
6057 // unsigned char fpr;
6058 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
6059 FieldNames[1] = "fpr";
6060
6061 // unsigned short reserved;
6062 FieldTypes[2] = Context->UnsignedShortTy;
6063 FieldNames[2] = "reserved";
6064
6065 // void* overflow_arg_area;
6066 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6067 FieldNames[3] = "overflow_arg_area";
6068
6069 // void* reg_save_area;
6070 FieldTypes[4] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6071 FieldNames[4] = "reg_save_area";
6072
6073 // Create fields
6074 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6075 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*Context, VaListTagDecl,
6076 SourceLocation(),
6077 SourceLocation(),
6078 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006079 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6080 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006081 /*Mutable=*/false,
6082 ICIS_NoInit);
6083 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6084 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6085 }
6086 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6087 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006088 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006089
6090 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006091 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
6092 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
6093
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006094 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6095 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6096
6097 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6098 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6099 QualType VaListTagArrayType
6100 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6101 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006102 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006103}
6104
6105static TypedefDecl *
6106CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6107 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6108 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006109 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006110 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6111
6112 const size_t NumFields = 4;
6113 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6114 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6115
6116 // unsigned gp_offset;
6117 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
6118 FieldNames[0] = "gp_offset";
6119
6120 // unsigned fp_offset;
6121 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
6122 FieldNames[1] = "fp_offset";
6123
6124 // void* overflow_arg_area;
6125 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6126 FieldNames[2] = "overflow_arg_area";
6127
6128 // void* reg_save_area;
6129 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6130 FieldNames[3] = "reg_save_area";
6131
6132 // Create fields
6133 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6134 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6135 VaListTagDecl,
6136 SourceLocation(),
6137 SourceLocation(),
6138 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006139 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6140 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006141 /*Mutable=*/false,
6142 ICIS_NoInit);
6143 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6144 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6145 }
6146 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6147 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006148 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006149
6150 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006151 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
6152 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
6153
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006154 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6155 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6156
6157 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6158 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6159 QualType VaListTagArrayType
6160 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6161 Size, ArrayType::Normal,0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006162 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006163}
6164
6165static TypedefDecl *CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6166 // typedef int __builtin_va_list[4];
6167 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 4);
6168 QualType IntArrayType
6169 = Context->getConstantArrayType(Context->IntTy,
6170 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006171 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(IntArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006172}
6173
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006174static TypedefDecl *
6175CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006176 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006177 RecordDecl *VaListDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006178 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6179 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
6180 NamespaceDecl *NS;
6181 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6182 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6183 /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
6184 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006185 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006186 NS->setImplicit();
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006187 VaListDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006188 }
6189
6190 VaListDecl->startDefinition();
6191
6192 // void * __ap;
6193 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6194 VaListDecl,
6195 SourceLocation(),
6196 SourceLocation(),
6197 &Context->Idents.get("__ap"),
6198 Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006199 /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6200 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006201 /*Mutable=*/false,
6202 ICIS_NoInit);
6203 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6204 VaListDecl->addDecl(Field);
6205
6206 // };
6207 VaListDecl->completeDefinition();
6208
6209 // typedef struct __va_list __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006210 QualType T = Context->getRecordType(VaListDecl);
6211 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006212}
6213
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006214static TypedefDecl *
6215CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6216 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6217 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006218 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006219 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6220
6221 const size_t NumFields = 4;
6222 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6223 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6224
6225 // long __gpr;
6226 FieldTypes[0] = Context->LongTy;
6227 FieldNames[0] = "__gpr";
6228
6229 // long __fpr;
6230 FieldTypes[1] = Context->LongTy;
6231 FieldNames[1] = "__fpr";
6232
6233 // void *__overflow_arg_area;
6234 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6235 FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_arg_area";
6236
6237 // void *__reg_save_area;
6238 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6239 FieldNames[3] = "__reg_save_area";
6240
6241 // Create fields
6242 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6243 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6244 VaListTagDecl,
6245 SourceLocation(),
6246 SourceLocation(),
6247 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006248 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6249 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006250 /*Mutable=*/false,
6251 ICIS_NoInit);
6252 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6253 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6254 }
6255 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6256 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6257 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
6258
6259 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006260 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
6261 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006262 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6263 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6264
6265 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6266 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6267 QualType VaListTagArrayType
6268 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6269 Size, ArrayType::Normal,0);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006270
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006271 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006272}
6273
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006274static TypedefDecl *CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6275 TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind) {
6276 switch (Kind) {
6277 case TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList:
6278 return CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6279 case TargetInfo::VoidPtrBuiltinVaList:
6280 return CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006281 case TargetInfo::AArch64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6282 return CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006283 case TargetInfo::PowerABIBuiltinVaList:
6284 return CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6285 case TargetInfo::X86_64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6286 return CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6287 case TargetInfo::PNaClABIBuiltinVaList:
6288 return CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006289 case TargetInfo::AAPCSABIBuiltinVaList:
6290 return CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006291 case TargetInfo::SystemZBuiltinVaList:
6292 return CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006293 }
6294
6295 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled __builtin_va_list type kind");
6296}
6297
6298TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinVaListDecl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006299 if (!BuiltinVaListDecl) {
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006300 BuiltinVaListDecl = CreateVaListDecl(this, Target->getBuiltinVaListKind());
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006301 assert(BuiltinVaListDecl->isImplicit());
6302 }
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006303
6304 return BuiltinVaListDecl;
6305}
6306
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006307QualType ASTContext::getVaListTagType() const {
6308 // Force the creation of VaListTagTy by building the __builtin_va_list
6309 // declaration.
6310 if (VaListTagTy.isNull())
6311 (void) getBuiltinVaListDecl();
6312
6313 return VaListTagTy;
6314}
6315
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006316void ASTContext::setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006317 assert(ObjCConstantStringType.isNull() &&
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006318 "'NSConstantString' type already set!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006319
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006320 ObjCConstantStringType = getObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006321}
6322
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006323/// \brief Retrieve the template name that corresponds to a non-empty
6324/// lookup.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006325TemplateName
6326ASTContext::getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
6327 UnresolvedSetIterator End) const {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006328 unsigned size = End - Begin;
6329 assert(size > 1 && "set is not overloaded!");
6330
6331 void *memory = Allocate(sizeof(OverloadedTemplateStorage) +
6332 size * sizeof(FunctionTemplateDecl*));
6333 OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = new(memory) OverloadedTemplateStorage(size);
6334
6335 NamedDecl **Storage = OT->getStorage();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00006336 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = Begin; I != End; ++I) {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006337 NamedDecl *D = *I;
6338 assert(isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) ||
6339 (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) &&
6340 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D->getUnderlyingDecl())));
6341 *Storage++ = D;
6342 }
6343
6344 return TemplateName(OT);
6345}
6346
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006347/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a qualified
6348/// template name such as \c std::vector.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006349TemplateName
6350ASTContext::getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6351 bool TemplateKeyword,
6352 TemplateDecl *Template) const {
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00006353 assert(NNS && "Missing nested-name-specifier in qualified template name");
6354
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006355 // FIXME: Canonicalization?
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006356 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6357 QualifiedTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
6358
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006359 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006360 QualifiedTemplateName *QTN =
6361 QualifiedTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6362 if (!QTN) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006363 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<QualifiedTemplateName>())
6364 QualifiedTemplateName(NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006365 QualifiedTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6366 }
6367
6368 return TemplateName(QTN);
6369}
6370
6371/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6372/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template apply.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006373TemplateName
6374ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6375 const IdentifierInfo *Name) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006376 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor308047d2009-09-09 00:23:06 +00006377 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006378
6379 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6380 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Name);
6381
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006382 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006383 DependentTemplateName *QTN =
6384 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6385
6386 if (QTN)
6387 return TemplateName(QTN);
6388
6389 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6390 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006391 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6392 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006393 } else {
6394 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Name);
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006395 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6396 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006397 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN =
6398 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6399 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent type name canonicalization broken");
6400 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006401 }
6402
6403 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6404 return TemplateName(QTN);
6405}
6406
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006407/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6408/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template operator+.
6409TemplateName
6410ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006411 OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const {
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006412 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
6413 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
6414
6415 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6416 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Operator);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006417
6418 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006419 DependentTemplateName *QTN
6420 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006421
6422 if (QTN)
6423 return TemplateName(QTN);
6424
6425 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6426 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006427 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6428 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006429 } else {
6430 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Operator);
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006431 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6432 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006433
6434 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN
6435 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6436 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent template name canonicalization broken");
6437 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006438 }
6439
6440 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6441 return TemplateName(QTN);
6442}
6443
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006444TemplateName
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006445ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *param,
6446 TemplateName replacement) const {
6447 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6448 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage::Profile(ID, param, replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006449
6450 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006451 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
6452 = SubstTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
6453
6454 if (!subst) {
6455 subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage(param, replacement);
6456 SubstTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(subst, insertPos);
6457 }
6458
6459 return TemplateName(subst);
6460}
6461
6462TemplateName
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006463ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param,
6464 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) const {
6465 ASTContext &Self = const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this);
6466 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6467 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage::Profile(ID, Self, Param, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006468
6469 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006470 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *Subst
6471 = SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6472
6473 if (!Subst) {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006474 Subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage(Param,
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006475 ArgPack.pack_size(),
6476 ArgPack.pack_begin());
6477 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.InsertNode(Subst, InsertPos);
6478 }
6479
6480 return TemplateName(Subst);
6481}
6482
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006483/// getFromTargetType - Given one of the integer types provided by
Douglas Gregorab138572008-11-03 15:57:00 +00006484/// TargetInfo, produce the corresponding type. The unsigned @p Type
6485/// is actually a value of type @c TargetInfo::IntType.
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006486CanQualType ASTContext::getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const {
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006487 switch (Type) {
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006488 case TargetInfo::NoInt: return CanQualType();
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00006489 case TargetInfo::SignedChar: return SignedCharTy;
6490 case TargetInfo::UnsignedChar: return UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006491 case TargetInfo::SignedShort: return ShortTy;
6492 case TargetInfo::UnsignedShort: return UnsignedShortTy;
6493 case TargetInfo::SignedInt: return IntTy;
6494 case TargetInfo::UnsignedInt: return UnsignedIntTy;
6495 case TargetInfo::SignedLong: return LongTy;
6496 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLong: return UnsignedLongTy;
6497 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: return LongLongTy;
6498 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLongLong: return UnsignedLongLongTy;
6499 }
6500
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00006501 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::IntType value");
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006502}
Ted Kremenek77c51b22008-07-24 23:58:27 +00006503
6504//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6505// Type Predicates.
6506//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6507
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006508/// getObjCGCAttr - Returns one of GCNone, Weak or Strong objc's
6509/// garbage collection attribute.
6510///
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006511Qualifiers::GC ASTContext::getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006512 if (getLangOpts().getGC() == LangOptions::NonGC)
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006513 return Qualifiers::GCNone;
6514
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006515 assert(getLangOpts().ObjC1);
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006516 Qualifiers::GC GCAttrs = Ty.getObjCGCAttr();
6517
6518 // Default behaviour under objective-C's gc is for ObjC pointers
6519 // (or pointers to them) be treated as though they were declared
6520 // as __strong.
6521 if (GCAttrs == Qualifiers::GCNone) {
6522 if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
6523 return Qualifiers::Strong;
6524 else if (Ty->isPointerType())
6525 return getObjCGCAttrKind(Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
6526 } else {
6527 // It's not valid to set GC attributes on anything that isn't a
6528 // pointer.
6529#ifndef NDEBUG
6530 QualType CT = Ty->getCanonicalTypeInternal();
6531 while (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CT))
6532 CT = AT->getElementType();
6533 assert(CT->isAnyPointerType() || CT->isBlockPointerType());
6534#endif
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006535 }
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00006536 return GCAttrs;
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006537}
6538
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006539//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6540// Type Compatibility Testing
6541//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattnerb338a6b2007-11-01 05:03:41 +00006542
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006543/// areCompatVectorTypes - Return true if the two specified vector types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006544/// compatible.
6545static bool areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType *LHS,
6546 const VectorType *RHS) {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00006547 assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified());
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006548 return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() &&
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006549 LHS->getNumElements() == RHS->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006550}
6551
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006552bool ASTContext::areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec,
6553 QualType SecondVec) {
6554 assert(FirstVec->isVectorType() && "FirstVec should be a vector type");
6555 assert(SecondVec->isVectorType() && "SecondVec should be a vector type");
6556
6557 if (hasSameUnqualifiedType(FirstVec, SecondVec))
6558 return true;
6559
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006560 // Treat Neon vector types and most AltiVec vector types as if they are the
6561 // equivalent GCC vector types.
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006562 const VectorType *First = FirstVec->getAs<VectorType>();
6563 const VectorType *Second = SecondVec->getAs<VectorType>();
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006564 if (First->getNumElements() == Second->getNumElements() &&
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006565 hasSameType(First->getElementType(), Second->getElementType()) &&
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006566 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6567 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
6568 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6569 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool)
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006570 return true;
6571
6572 return false;
6573}
6574
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006575//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6576// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - Compatibility testing for qualified id's.
6577//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6578
6579/// ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol - return 'true' if 'lProto' is in the
6580/// inheritance hierarchy of 'rProto'.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006581bool
6582ASTContext::ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl *lProto,
6583 ObjCProtocolDecl *rProto) const {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00006584 if (declaresSameEntity(lProto, rProto))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006585 return true;
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00006586 for (auto *PI : rProto->protocols())
6587 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lProto, PI))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006588 return true;
6589 return false;
6590}
6591
Dmitri Gribenko4364fcf2012-08-28 02:49:14 +00006592/// ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible - compare Class<pr,...> and
6593/// Class<pr1, ...>.
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006594bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs,
6595 QualType rhs) {
6596 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6597 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6598 assert ((lhsQID && rhsOPT) && "ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible");
6599
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006600 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006601 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006602 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006603 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto)) {
6604 match = true;
6605 break;
6606 }
6607 }
6608 if (!match)
6609 return false;
6610 }
6611 return true;
6612}
6613
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006614/// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - We know that one of lhs/rhs is an
6615/// ObjCQualifiedIDType.
6616bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6617 bool compare) {
6618 // Allow id<P..> and an 'id' or void* type in all cases.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006619 if (lhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006620 lhs->isObjCIdType() || lhs->isObjCClassType())
6621 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006622 else if (rhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006623 rhs->isObjCIdType() || rhs->isObjCClassType())
6624 return true;
6625
6626 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006627 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006628
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006629 if (!rhsOPT) return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006630
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006631 if (rhsOPT->qual_empty()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006632 // If the RHS is a unqualified interface pointer "NSString*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006633 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6634 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006635 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006636 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6637 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6638 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006639 if (!rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006640 return false;
6641 }
6642 }
6643 // If there are no qualifiers and no interface, we have an 'id'.
6644 return true;
6645 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006646 // Both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006647 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006648 bool match = false;
6649
6650 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6651 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6652 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006653 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006654 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6655 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6656 match = true;
6657 break;
6658 }
6659 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006660 // If the RHS is a qualified interface pointer "NSString<P>*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006661 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6662 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006663 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006664 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6665 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6666 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006667 if (rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true)) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006668 match = true;
6669 break;
6670 }
6671 }
6672 }
6673 if (!match)
6674 return false;
6675 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006676
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006677 return true;
6678 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006679
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006680 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsQID = rhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType();
6681 assert(rhsQID && "One of the LHS/RHS should be id<x>");
6682
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006683 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT =
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006684 lhs->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006685 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006686 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006687 bool match = false;
6688
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006689 // when comparing an id<P> on rhs with a static type on lhs,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006690 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6691 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006692 // First, lhs protocols in the qualifier list must be found, direct
6693 // or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006694 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006695 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6696 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6697 match = true;
6698 break;
6699 }
6700 }
6701 if (!match)
6702 return false;
6703 }
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006704
6705 // Static class's protocols, or its super class or category protocols
6706 // must be found, direct or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
6707 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *lhsID = lhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6708 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
6709 CollectInheritedProtocols(lhsID, LHSInheritedProtocols);
6710 // This is rather dubious but matches gcc's behavior. If lhs has
6711 // no type qualifier and its class has no static protocol(s)
6712 // assume that it is mismatch.
6713 if (LHSInheritedProtocols.empty() && lhsOPT->qual_empty())
6714 return false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006715 for (auto *lhsProto : LHSInheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006716 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006717 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006718 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6719 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6720 match = true;
6721 break;
6722 }
6723 }
6724 if (!match)
6725 return false;
6726 }
6727 }
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006728 return true;
6729 }
6730 return false;
6731}
6732
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006733/// canAssignObjCInterfaces - Return true if the two interface types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006734/// compatible for assignment from RHS to LHS. This handles validation of any
6735/// protocol qualifiers on the LHS or RHS.
6736///
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006737bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6738 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006739 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6740 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6741
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00006742 // If either type represents the built-in 'id' or 'Class' types, return true.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006743 if (LHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass() ||
6744 RHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006745 return true;
6746
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006747 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCQualifiedId())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006748 return ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6749 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006750 false);
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006751
6752 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedClass() && RHS->isObjCQualifiedClass())
6753 return ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6754 QualType(RHSOPT,0));
6755
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006756 // If we have 2 user-defined types, fall into that path.
6757 if (LHS->getInterface() && RHS->getInterface())
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006758 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006759
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006760 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006761}
6762
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006763/// canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer - This routine is specifically written
Chris Lattner57540c52011-04-15 05:22:18 +00006764/// for providing type-safety for objective-c pointers used to pass/return
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006765/// arguments in block literals. When passed as arguments, passing 'A*' where
6766/// 'id' is expected is not OK. Passing 'Sub *" where 'Super *" is expected is
6767/// not OK. For the return type, the opposite is not OK.
6768bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
6769 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006770 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
6771 bool BlockReturnType) {
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00006772 if (RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || LHSOPT->isObjCIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006773 return true;
6774
6775 if (LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
6776 return RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType();
6777 }
6778
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00006779 if (LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006780 return ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6781 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
6782 false);
6783
6784 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = LHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6785 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = RHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6786 if (LHS && RHS) { // We have 2 user-defined types.
6787 if (LHS != RHS) {
6788 if (LHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getDecl()))
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006789 return BlockReturnType;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006790 if (RHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(LHS->getDecl()))
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006791 return !BlockReturnType;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006792 }
6793 else
6794 return true;
6795 }
6796 return false;
6797}
6798
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006799/// getIntersectionOfProtocols - This routine finds the intersection of set
6800/// of protocols inherited from two distinct objective-c pointer objects.
6801/// It is used to build composite qualifier list of the composite type of
6802/// the conditional expression involving two objective-c pointer objects.
6803static
6804void getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext &Context,
6805 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6806 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006807 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &IntersectionOfProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006808
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006809 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6810 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6811 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS must have an interface base");
6812 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS must have an interface base");
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006813
6814 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocolSet;
6815 unsigned LHSNumProtocols = LHS->getNumProtocols();
6816 if (LHSNumProtocols > 0)
6817 InheritedProtocolSet.insert(LHS->qual_begin(), LHS->qual_end());
6818 else {
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006819 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006820 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(LHS->getInterface(),
6821 LHSInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006822 InheritedProtocolSet.insert(LHSInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6823 LHSInheritedProtocols.end());
6824 }
6825
6826 unsigned RHSNumProtocols = RHS->getNumProtocols();
6827 if (RHSNumProtocols > 0) {
Dan Gohman145f3f12010-04-19 16:39:44 +00006828 ObjCProtocolDecl **RHSProtocols =
6829 const_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl **>(RHS->qual_begin());
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006830 for (unsigned i = 0; i < RHSNumProtocols; ++i)
6831 if (InheritedProtocolSet.count(RHSProtocols[i]))
6832 IntersectionOfProtocols.push_back(RHSProtocols[i]);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00006833 } else {
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006834 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> RHSInheritedProtocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006835 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(),
6836 RHSInheritedProtocols);
Craig Topperc6914d02014-08-25 04:15:02 +00006837 for (ObjCProtocolDecl *ProtDecl : RHSInheritedProtocols)
6838 if (InheritedProtocolSet.count(ProtDecl))
6839 IntersectionOfProtocols.push_back(ProtDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006840 }
6841}
6842
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006843/// areCommonBaseCompatible - Returns common base class of the two classes if
6844/// one found. Note that this is O'2 algorithm. But it will be called as the
6845/// last type comparison in a ?-exp of ObjC pointer types before a
6846/// warning is issued. So, its invokation is extremely rare.
6847QualType ASTContext::areCommonBaseCompatible(
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006848 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Lptr,
6849 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Rptr) {
6850 const ObjCObjectType *LHS = Lptr->getObjectType();
6851 const ObjCObjectType *RHS = Rptr->getObjectType();
6852 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* LDecl = LHS->getInterface();
6853 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* RDecl = RHS->getInterface();
Douglas Gregor0b144e12011-12-15 00:29:59 +00006854 if (!LDecl || !RDecl || (declaresSameEntity(LDecl, RDecl)))
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006855 return QualType();
6856
Fariborz Jahanianb1071432011-04-18 21:16:59 +00006857 do {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006858 LHS = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(getObjCInterfaceType(LDecl));
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006859 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS)) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006860 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006861 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, Lptr, Rptr, Protocols);
6862
6863 QualType Result = QualType(LHS, 0);
6864 if (!Protocols.empty())
6865 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, Protocols.data(), Protocols.size());
6866 Result = getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
6867 return Result;
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006868 }
Fariborz Jahanianb1071432011-04-18 21:16:59 +00006869 } while ((LDecl = LDecl->getSuperClass()));
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006870
6871 return QualType();
6872}
6873
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006874bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType *LHS,
6875 const ObjCObjectType *RHS) {
6876 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS is not an interface type");
6877 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS is not an interface type");
6878
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006879 // Verify that the base decls are compatible: the RHS must be a subclass of
6880 // the LHS.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006881 if (!LHS->getInterface()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface()))
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006882 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006883
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006884 // RHS must have a superset of the protocols in the LHS. If the LHS is not
6885 // protocol qualified at all, then we are good.
Steve Naroffc277ad12009-07-18 15:33:26 +00006886 if (LHS->getNumProtocols() == 0)
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006887 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006888
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00006889 // Okay, we know the LHS has protocol qualifiers. But RHS may or may not.
6890 // More detailed analysis is required.
6891 // OK, if LHS is same or a superclass of RHS *and*
6892 // this LHS, or as RHS's super class is assignment compatible with LHS.
6893 bool IsSuperClass =
6894 LHS->getInterface()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface());
6895 if (IsSuperClass) {
6896 // OK if conversion of LHS to SuperClass results in narrowing of types
6897 // ; i.e., SuperClass may implement at least one of the protocols
6898 // in LHS's protocol list. Example, SuperObj<P1> = lhs<P1,P2> is ok.
6899 // But not SuperObj<P1,P2,P3> = lhs<P1,P2>.
6900 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> SuperClassInheritedProtocols;
6901 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
6902 // Also, if RHS has explicit quelifiers, include them for comparing with LHS's
6903 // qualifiers.
6904 for (auto *RHSPI : RHS->quals())
6905 SuperClassInheritedProtocols.insert(RHSPI->getCanonicalDecl());
6906 // If there is no protocols associated with RHS, it is not a match.
6907 if (SuperClassInheritedProtocols.empty())
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006908 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00006909
6910 for (const auto *LHSProto : LHS->quals()) {
6911 bool SuperImplementsProtocol = false;
6912 for (auto *SuperClassProto : SuperClassInheritedProtocols)
6913 if (SuperClassProto->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSProto->getIdentifier())) {
6914 SuperImplementsProtocol = true;
6915 break;
6916 }
6917 if (!SuperImplementsProtocol)
6918 return false;
6919 }
6920 return true;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006921 }
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00006922 return false;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006923}
6924
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006925bool ASTContext::areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
6926 // get the "pointed to" types
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006927 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6928 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006929
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006930 if (!LHSOPT || !RHSOPT)
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006931 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006932
6933 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT) ||
6934 canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT);
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006935}
6936
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00006937bool ASTContext::canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To, QualType From) {
6938 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(
6939 getObjCObjectPointerType(To)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
6940 getObjCObjectPointerType(From)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>());
6941}
6942
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006943/// typesAreCompatible - C99 6.7.3p9: For two qualified types to be compatible,
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00006944/// both shall have the identically qualified version of a compatible type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006945/// C99 6.2.7p1: Two types have compatible types if their types are the
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00006946/// same. See 6.7.[2,3,5] for additional rules.
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006947bool ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
6948 bool CompareUnqualified) {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006949 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00006950 return hasSameType(LHS, RHS);
6951
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006952 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, false, CompareUnqualified).isNull();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006953}
6954
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00006955bool ASTContext::propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
Fariborz Jahanianc87c8792011-07-12 23:20:13 +00006956 return typesAreCompatible(LHS, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00006957}
6958
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006959bool ASTContext::typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
6960 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true).isNull();
6961}
6962
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006963/// mergeTransparentUnionType - if T is a transparent union type and a member
6964/// of T is compatible with SubType, return the merged type, else return
6965/// QualType()
6966QualType ASTContext::mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T, QualType SubType,
6967 bool OfBlockPointer,
6968 bool Unqualified) {
6969 if (const RecordType *UT = T->getAsUnionType()) {
6970 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
6971 if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00006972 for (const auto *I : UD->fields()) {
6973 QualType ET = I->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006974 QualType MT = mergeTypes(ET, SubType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6975 if (!MT.isNull())
6976 return MT;
6977 }
6978 }
6979 }
6980
6981 return QualType();
6982}
6983
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00006984/// mergeFunctionParameterTypes - merge two types which appear as function
6985/// parameter types
6986QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionParameterTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6987 bool OfBlockPointer,
6988 bool Unqualified) {
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006989 // GNU extension: two types are compatible if they appear as a function
6990 // argument, one of the types is a transparent union type and the other
6991 // type is compatible with a union member
6992 QualType lmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer,
6993 Unqualified);
6994 if (!lmerge.isNull())
6995 return lmerge;
6996
6997 QualType rmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(rhs, lhs, OfBlockPointer,
6998 Unqualified);
6999 if (!rmerge.isNull())
7000 return rmerge;
7001
7002 return mergeTypes(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7003}
7004
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007005QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007006 bool OfBlockPointer,
7007 bool Unqualified) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007008 const FunctionType *lbase = lhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
7009 const FunctionType *rbase = rhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007010 const FunctionProtoType *lproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(lbase);
7011 const FunctionProtoType *rproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(rbase);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007012 bool allLTypes = true;
7013 bool allRTypes = true;
7014
7015 // Check return type
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007016 QualType retType;
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00007017 if (OfBlockPointer) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007018 QualType RHS = rbase->getReturnType();
7019 QualType LHS = lbase->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00007020 bool UnqualifiedResult = Unqualified;
7021 if (!UnqualifiedResult)
7022 UnqualifiedResult = (!RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers());
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007023 retType = mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true, UnqualifiedResult, true);
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00007024 }
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007025 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007026 retType = mergeTypes(lbase->getReturnType(), rbase->getReturnType(), false,
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007027 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007028 if (retType.isNull()) return QualType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007029
7030 if (Unqualified)
7031 retType = retType.getUnqualifiedType();
7032
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007033 CanQualType LRetType = getCanonicalType(lbase->getReturnType());
7034 CanQualType RRetType = getCanonicalType(rbase->getReturnType());
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007035 if (Unqualified) {
7036 LRetType = LRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
7037 RRetType = RRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
7038 }
7039
7040 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != LRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007041 allLTypes = false;
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007042 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != RRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007043 allRTypes = false;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007044
Daniel Dunbaredd5bae2010-04-28 16:20:58 +00007045 // FIXME: double check this
7046 // FIXME: should we error if lbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
7047 // rbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
7048 // lbase->getRegParmAttr() != rbase->getRegParmAttr()?
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00007049 FunctionType::ExtInfo lbaseInfo = lbase->getExtInfo();
7050 FunctionType::ExtInfo rbaseInfo = rbase->getExtInfo();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007051
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00007052 // Compatible functions must have compatible calling conventions
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007053 if (lbaseInfo.getCC() != rbaseInfo.getCC())
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00007054 return QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007055
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007056 // Regparm is part of the calling convention.
Eli Friedmanc5b20b52011-04-09 08:18:08 +00007057 if (lbaseInfo.getHasRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getHasRegParm())
7058 return QualType();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007059 if (lbaseInfo.getRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getRegParm())
7060 return QualType();
7061
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007062 if (lbaseInfo.getProducesResult() != rbaseInfo.getProducesResult())
7063 return QualType();
7064
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007065 // FIXME: some uses, e.g. conditional exprs, really want this to be 'both'.
7066 bool NoReturn = lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() || rbaseInfo.getNoReturn();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007067
Rafael Espindola8778c282012-11-29 16:09:03 +00007068 if (lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
7069 allLTypes = false;
7070 if (rbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
7071 allRTypes = false;
7072
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007073 FunctionType::ExtInfo einfo = lbaseInfo.withNoReturn(NoReturn);
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007074
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007075 if (lproto && rproto) { // two C99 style function prototypes
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00007076 assert(!lproto->hasExceptionSpec() && !rproto->hasExceptionSpec() &&
7077 "C++ shouldn't be here");
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007078 // Compatible functions must have the same number of parameters
7079 if (lproto->getNumParams() != rproto->getNumParams())
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007080 return QualType();
7081
7082 // Variadic and non-variadic functions aren't compatible
7083 if (lproto->isVariadic() != rproto->isVariadic())
7084 return QualType();
7085
Argyrios Kyrtzidis22a37352008-10-26 16:43:14 +00007086 if (lproto->getTypeQuals() != rproto->getTypeQuals())
7087 return QualType();
7088
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007089 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
7090 !FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(rproto, lproto))
7091 return QualType();
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007092
7093 // Check parameter type compatibility
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007094 SmallVector<QualType, 10> types;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007095 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lproto->getNumParams(); i < n; i++) {
7096 QualType lParamType = lproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
7097 QualType rParamType = rproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
7098 QualType paramType = mergeFunctionParameterTypes(
7099 lParamType, rParamType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7100 if (paramType.isNull())
7101 return QualType();
7102
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007103 if (Unqualified)
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007104 paramType = paramType.getUnqualifiedType();
7105
7106 types.push_back(paramType);
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007107 if (Unqualified) {
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007108 lParamType = lParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
7109 rParamType = rParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007110 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007111
7112 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(lParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007113 allLTypes = false;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007114 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(rParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007115 allRTypes = false;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007116 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007117
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007118 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7119 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007120
7121 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = lproto->getExtProtoInfo();
7122 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00007123 return getFunctionType(retType, types, EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007124 }
7125
7126 if (lproto) allRTypes = false;
7127 if (rproto) allLTypes = false;
7128
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007129 const FunctionProtoType *proto = lproto ? lproto : rproto;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007130 if (proto) {
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00007131 assert(!proto->hasExceptionSpec() && "C++ shouldn't be here");
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007132 if (proto->isVariadic()) return QualType();
7133 // Check that the types are compatible with the types that
7134 // would result from default argument promotions (C99 6.7.5.3p15).
7135 // The only types actually affected are promotable integer
7136 // types and floats, which would be passed as a different
7137 // type depending on whether the prototype is visible.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007138 for (unsigned i = 0, n = proto->getNumParams(); i < n; ++i) {
7139 QualType paramTy = proto->getParamType(i);
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007140
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00007141 // Look at the converted type of enum types, since that is the type used
Douglas Gregor2973d402010-02-03 19:27:29 +00007142 // to pass enum values.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007143 if (const EnumType *Enum = paramTy->getAs<EnumType>()) {
7144 paramTy = Enum->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7145 if (paramTy.isNull())
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00007146 return QualType();
7147 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007148
7149 if (paramTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ||
7150 getCanonicalType(paramTy).getUnqualifiedType() == FloatTy)
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007151 return QualType();
7152 }
7153
7154 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7155 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007156
7157 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = proto->getExtProtoInfo();
7158 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007159 return getFunctionType(retType, proto->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007160 }
7161
7162 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7163 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007164 return getFunctionNoProtoType(retType, einfo);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007165}
7166
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007167/// Given that we have an enum type and a non-enum type, try to merge them.
7168static QualType mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext &Context, const EnumType *ET,
7169 QualType other, bool isBlockReturnType) {
7170 // C99 6.7.2.2p4: Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char,
7171 // a signed integer type, or an unsigned integer type.
7172 // Compatibility is based on the underlying type, not the promotion
7173 // type.
7174 QualType underlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7175 if (underlyingType.isNull()) return QualType();
7176 if (Context.hasSameType(underlyingType, other))
7177 return other;
7178
7179 // In block return types, we're more permissive and accept any
7180 // integral type of the same size.
7181 if (isBlockReturnType && other->isIntegerType() &&
7182 Context.getTypeSize(underlyingType) == Context.getTypeSize(other))
7183 return other;
7184
7185 return QualType();
7186}
7187
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007188QualType ASTContext::mergeTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007189 bool OfBlockPointer,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007190 bool Unqualified, bool BlockReturnType) {
Bill Wendlingdb4e3492007-12-03 07:33:35 +00007191 // C++ [expr]: If an expression initially has the type "reference to T", the
7192 // type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further analysis, the expression
7193 // designates the object or function denoted by the reference, and the
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007194 // expression is an lvalue unless the reference is an rvalue reference and
7195 // the expression is a function call (possibly inside parentheses).
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007196 assert(!LHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "LHS is a reference type?");
7197 assert(!RHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "RHS is a reference type?");
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007198
7199 if (Unqualified) {
7200 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7201 RHS = RHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7202 }
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007203
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007204 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7205 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7206
7207 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7208 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7209 return LHS;
7210
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007211 // If the qualifiers are different, the types aren't compatible... mostly.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00007212 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7213 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007214 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7215 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type
7216 // mismatch.
7217 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007218 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace() ||
7219 LQuals.getObjCLifetime() != RQuals.getObjCLifetime())
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007220 return QualType();
7221
7222 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7223 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7224 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7225 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7226 // qualified __strong.
7227 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7228 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7229 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7230
7231 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7232 return QualType();
7233
7234 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7235 return mergeTypes(LHS, getObjCGCQualType(RHS, Qualifiers::Strong));
7236 }
7237 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong && LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7238 return mergeTypes(getObjCGCQualType(LHS, Qualifiers::Strong), RHS);
7239 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007240 return QualType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007241 }
7242
7243 // Okay, qualifiers are equal.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007244
Eli Friedmandcca6332009-06-01 01:22:52 +00007245 Type::TypeClass LHSClass = LHSCan->getTypeClass();
7246 Type::TypeClass RHSClass = RHSCan->getTypeClass();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007247
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007248 // We want to consider the two function types to be the same for these
7249 // comparisons, just force one to the other.
7250 if (LHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) LHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
7251 if (RHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) RHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
Eli Friedman16f90962008-02-12 08:23:06 +00007252
7253 // Same as above for arrays
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007254 if (LHSClass == Type::VariableArray || LHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7255 LHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
7256 if (RHSClass == Type::VariableArray || RHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7257 RHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007258
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007259 // ObjCInterfaces are just specialized ObjCObjects.
7260 if (LHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) LHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7261 if (RHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) RHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7262
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00007263 // Canonicalize ExtVector -> Vector.
7264 if (LHSClass == Type::ExtVector) LHSClass = Type::Vector;
7265 if (RHSClass == Type::ExtVector) RHSClass = Type::Vector;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007266
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007267 // If the canonical type classes don't match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007268 if (LHSClass != RHSClass) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007269 // Note that we only have special rules for turning block enum
7270 // returns into block int returns, not vice-versa.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007271 if (const EnumType* ETy = LHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007272 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, RHS, false);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007273 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007274 if (const EnumType* ETy = RHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007275 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, LHS, BlockReturnType);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007276 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007277 // allow block pointer type to match an 'id' type.
Fariborz Jahanian194904e2012-01-26 17:08:50 +00007278 if (OfBlockPointer && !BlockReturnType) {
7279 if (LHS->isObjCIdType() && RHS->isBlockPointerType())
7280 return LHS;
7281 if (RHS->isObjCIdType() && LHS->isBlockPointerType())
7282 return RHS;
7283 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007284
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007285 return QualType();
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007286 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007287
Steve Naroffc6edcbd2008-01-09 22:43:08 +00007288 // The canonical type classes match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007289 switch (LHSClass) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007290#define TYPE(Class, Base)
7291#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
John McCallbd8d9bd2010-03-01 23:49:17 +00007292#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007293#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7294#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7295#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007296 llvm_unreachable("Non-canonical and dependent types shouldn't get here");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007297
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00007298 case Type::Auto:
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007299 case Type::LValueReference:
7300 case Type::RValueReference:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007301 case Type::MemberPointer:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007302 llvm_unreachable("C++ should never be in mergeTypes");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007303
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007304 case Type::ObjCInterface:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007305 case Type::IncompleteArray:
7306 case Type::VariableArray:
7307 case Type::FunctionProto:
7308 case Type::ExtVector:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007309 llvm_unreachable("Types are eliminated above");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007310
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007311 case Type::Pointer:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007312 {
7313 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007314 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7315 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007316 if (Unqualified) {
7317 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7318 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7319 }
7320 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, false,
7321 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007322 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007323 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007324 return LHS;
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007325 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007326 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007327 return getPointerType(ResultType);
7328 }
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007329 case Type::BlockPointer:
7330 {
7331 // Merge two block pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007332 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7333 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007334 if (Unqualified) {
7335 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7336 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7337 }
7338 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, OfBlockPointer,
7339 Unqualified);
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007340 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7341 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7342 return LHS;
7343 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7344 return RHS;
7345 return getBlockPointerType(ResultType);
7346 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00007347 case Type::Atomic:
7348 {
7349 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
7350 QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7351 QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7352 if (Unqualified) {
7353 LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7354 RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7355 }
7356 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
7357 Unqualified);
7358 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7359 if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7360 return LHS;
7361 if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7362 return RHS;
7363 return getAtomicType(ResultType);
7364 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007365 case Type::ConstantArray:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007366 {
7367 const ConstantArrayType* LCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(LHS);
7368 const ConstantArrayType* RCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(RHS);
7369 if (LCAT && RCAT && RCAT->getSize() != LCAT->getSize())
7370 return QualType();
7371
7372 QualType LHSElem = getAsArrayType(LHS)->getElementType();
7373 QualType RHSElem = getAsArrayType(RHS)->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007374 if (Unqualified) {
7375 LHSElem = LHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7376 RHSElem = RHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7377 }
7378
7379 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSElem, RHSElem, false, Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007380 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007381 if (LCAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7382 return LHS;
7383 if (RCAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7384 return RHS;
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007385 if (LCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, LCAT->getSize(),
7386 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
7387 if (RCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, RCAT->getSize(),
7388 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007389 const VariableArrayType* LVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(LHS);
7390 const VariableArrayType* RVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(RHS);
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007391 if (LVAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7392 return LHS;
7393 if (RVAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7394 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007395 if (LVAT) {
7396 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7397 // the array's size has to be the size of LHS, but the type
7398 // has to be different.
7399 return LHS;
7400 }
7401 if (RVAT) {
7402 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7403 // the array's size has to be the size of RHS, but the type
7404 // has to be different.
7405 return RHS;
7406 }
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007407 if (getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return LHS;
7408 if (getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return RHS;
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00007409 return getIncompleteArrayType(ResultType,
7410 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007411 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007412 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007413 return mergeFunctionTypes(LHS, RHS, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007414 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007415 case Type::Enum:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007416 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007417 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007418 // Only exactly equal builtin types are compatible, which is tested above.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007419 return QualType();
Daniel Dunbar804c0442009-01-28 21:22:12 +00007420 case Type::Complex:
7421 // Distinct complex types are incompatible.
7422 return QualType();
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007423 case Type::Vector:
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007424 // FIXME: The merged type should be an ExtVector!
John McCall44c064b2010-03-12 23:14:13 +00007425 if (areCompatVectorTypes(LHSCan->getAs<VectorType>(),
7426 RHSCan->getAs<VectorType>()))
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007427 return LHS;
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007428 return QualType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007429 case Type::ObjCObject: {
7430 // Check if the types are assignment compatible.
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007431 // FIXME: This should be type compatibility, e.g. whether
7432 // "LHS x; RHS x;" at global scope is legal.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007433 const ObjCObjectType* LHSIface = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7434 const ObjCObjectType* RHSIface = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7435 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSIface, RHSIface))
Steve Naroff7a7814c2009-02-21 16:18:07 +00007436 return LHS;
7437
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007438 return QualType();
Cedric Venet4fc88b72009-02-21 17:14:49 +00007439 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007440 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007441 if (OfBlockPointer) {
7442 if (canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7443 LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007444 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7445 BlockReturnType))
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007446 return LHS;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007447 return QualType();
7448 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007449 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7450 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007451 return LHS;
7452
Steve Naroffc68cfcf2008-12-10 22:14:21 +00007453 return QualType();
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007454 }
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007455 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007456
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007457 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Type::Class!");
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007458}
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00007459
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007460bool ASTContext::FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(
7461 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType,
7462 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType) {
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007463 if (FromFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedParams() !=
7464 ToFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedParams())
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007465 return false;
7466 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo FromEPI =
7467 FromFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
7468 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ToEPI =
7469 ToFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00007470 if (FromEPI.ConsumedParameters && ToEPI.ConsumedParameters)
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007471 for (unsigned i = 0, n = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); i != n; ++i) {
7472 if (FromEPI.ConsumedParameters[i] != ToEPI.ConsumedParameters[i])
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007473 return false;
7474 }
7475 return true;
7476}
7477
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007478/// mergeObjCGCQualifiers - This routine merges ObjC's GC attribute of 'LHS' and
7479/// 'RHS' attributes and returns the merged version; including for function
7480/// return types.
7481QualType ASTContext::mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7482 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7483 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7484 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7485 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7486 return LHS;
7487 if (RHSCan->isFunctionType()) {
7488 if (!LHSCan->isFunctionType())
7489 return QualType();
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007490 QualType OldReturnType =
7491 cast<FunctionType>(RHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007492 QualType NewReturnType =
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007493 cast<FunctionType>(LHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007494 QualType ResReturnType =
7495 mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewReturnType, OldReturnType);
7496 if (ResReturnType.isNull())
7497 return QualType();
7498 if (ResReturnType == NewReturnType || ResReturnType == OldReturnType) {
7499 // id foo(); ... __strong id foo(); or: __strong id foo(); ... id foo();
7500 // In either case, use OldReturnType to build the new function type.
7501 const FunctionType *F = LHS->getAs<FunctionType>();
7502 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(F)) {
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007503 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
7504 EPI.ExtInfo = getFunctionExtInfo(LHS);
Reid Kleckner896b32f2013-06-10 20:51:09 +00007505 QualType ResultType =
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007506 getFunctionType(OldReturnType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007507 return ResultType;
7508 }
7509 }
7510 return QualType();
7511 }
7512
7513 // If the qualifiers are different, the types can still be merged.
7514 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7515 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7516 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7517 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type mismatch.
7518 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
7519 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace())
7520 return QualType();
7521
7522 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7523 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7524 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7525 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7526 // qualified __strong.
7527 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7528 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7529 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7530
7531 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7532 return QualType();
7533
7534 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong)
7535 return LHS;
7536 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong)
7537 return RHS;
7538 return QualType();
7539 }
7540
7541 if (LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7542 QualType LHSBaseQT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7543 QualType RHSBaseQT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7544 QualType ResQT = mergeObjCGCQualifiers(LHSBaseQT, RHSBaseQT);
7545 if (ResQT == LHSBaseQT)
7546 return LHS;
7547 if (ResQT == RHSBaseQT)
7548 return RHS;
7549 }
7550 return QualType();
7551}
7552
Chris Lattner4ba0cef2008-04-07 07:01:58 +00007553//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007554// Integer Predicates
7555//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner3c919712009-01-16 07:15:35 +00007556
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007557unsigned ASTContext::getIntWidth(QualType T) const {
Richard Smithe9521062013-10-15 04:56:17 +00007558 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedmanee275c82009-12-10 22:29:29 +00007559 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00007560 if (T->isBooleanType())
7561 return 1;
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00007562 // For builtin types, just use the standard type sizing method
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007563 return (unsigned)getTypeSize(T);
7564}
7565
Abramo Bagnara13640492012-09-09 10:21:24 +00007566QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00007567 assert(T->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() && "Unexpected type");
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007568
7569 // Turn <4 x signed int> -> <4 x unsigned int>
7570 if (const VectorType *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>())
7571 return getVectorType(getCorrespondingUnsignedType(VTy->getElementType()),
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00007572 VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind());
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007573
7574 // For enums, we return the unsigned version of the base type.
7575 if (const EnumType *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007576 T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007577
7578 const BuiltinType *BTy = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
7579 assert(BTy && "Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007580 switch (BTy->getKind()) {
7581 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
7582 case BuiltinType::SChar:
7583 return UnsignedCharTy;
7584 case BuiltinType::Short:
7585 return UnsignedShortTy;
7586 case BuiltinType::Int:
7587 return UnsignedIntTy;
7588 case BuiltinType::Long:
7589 return UnsignedLongTy;
7590 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
7591 return UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00007592 case BuiltinType::Int128:
7593 return UnsignedInt128Ty;
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007594 default:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007595 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007596 }
7597}
7598
Argyrios Kyrtzidis65ad5692010-10-24 17:26:36 +00007599ASTMutationListener::~ASTMutationListener() { }
7600
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00007601void ASTMutationListener::DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl *FD,
7602 QualType ReturnType) {}
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007603
7604//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7605// Builtin Type Computation
7606//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7607
7608/// DecodeTypeFromStr - This decodes one type descriptor from Str, advancing the
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007609/// pointer over the consumed characters. This returns the resultant type. If
7610/// AllowTypeModifiers is false then modifier like * are not parsed, just basic
7611/// types. This allows "v2i*" to be parsed as a pointer to a v2i instead of
7612/// a vector of "i*".
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007613///
7614/// RequiresICE is filled in on return to indicate whether the value is required
7615/// to be an Integer Constant Expression.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007616static QualType DecodeTypeFromStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context,
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007617 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007618 bool &RequiresICE,
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007619 bool AllowTypeModifiers) {
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007620 // Modifiers.
7621 int HowLong = 0;
7622 bool Signed = false, Unsigned = false;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007623 RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007624
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007625 // Read the prefixed modifiers first.
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007626 bool Done = false;
7627 while (!Done) {
7628 switch (*Str++) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007629 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007630 case 'I':
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007631 RequiresICE = true;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007632 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007633 case 'S':
7634 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
7635 assert(!Signed && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
7636 Signed = true;
7637 break;
7638 case 'U':
7639 assert(!Signed && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
Sean Silva2a995142015-01-16 21:44:26 +00007640 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use 'U' modifier multiple times!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007641 Unsigned = true;
7642 break;
7643 case 'L':
7644 assert(HowLong <= 2 && "Can't have LLLL modifier");
7645 ++HowLong;
7646 break;
Kevin Qinad64f6d2014-02-24 02:45:03 +00007647 case 'W':
7648 // This modifier represents int64 type.
7649 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'W' modifiers!");
7650 switch (Context.getTargetInfo().getInt64Type()) {
7651 default:
7652 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer type");
7653 case TargetInfo::SignedLong:
7654 HowLong = 1;
7655 break;
7656 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong:
7657 HowLong = 2;
7658 break;
7659 }
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007660 }
7661 }
7662
7663 QualType Type;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007664
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007665 // Read the base type.
7666 switch (*Str++) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007667 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type letter!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007668 case 'v':
7669 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7670 "Bad modifiers used with 'v'!");
7671 Type = Context.VoidTy;
7672 break;
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00007673 case 'h':
7674 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
Sean Silva2a995142015-01-16 21:44:26 +00007675 "Bad modifiers used with 'h'!");
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00007676 Type = Context.HalfTy;
7677 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007678 case 'f':
7679 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7680 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
7681 Type = Context.FloatTy;
7682 break;
7683 case 'd':
7684 assert(HowLong < 2 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7685 "Bad modifiers used with 'd'!");
7686 if (HowLong)
7687 Type = Context.LongDoubleTy;
7688 else
7689 Type = Context.DoubleTy;
7690 break;
7691 case 's':
7692 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 's'!");
7693 if (Unsigned)
7694 Type = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
7695 else
7696 Type = Context.ShortTy;
7697 break;
7698 case 'i':
7699 if (HowLong == 3)
7700 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedInt128Ty : Context.Int128Ty;
7701 else if (HowLong == 2)
7702 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
7703 else if (HowLong == 1)
7704 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
7705 else
7706 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
7707 break;
7708 case 'c':
7709 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 'c'!");
7710 if (Signed)
7711 Type = Context.SignedCharTy;
7712 else if (Unsigned)
7713 Type = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
7714 else
7715 Type = Context.CharTy;
7716 break;
7717 case 'b': // boolean
7718 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'b'!");
7719 Type = Context.BoolTy;
7720 break;
7721 case 'z': // size_t.
7722 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'z'!");
7723 Type = Context.getSizeType();
7724 break;
7725 case 'F':
7726 Type = Context.getCFConstantStringType();
7727 break;
Fariborz Jahaniand11da7e2010-11-09 21:38:20 +00007728 case 'G':
7729 Type = Context.getObjCIdType();
7730 break;
7731 case 'H':
7732 Type = Context.getObjCSelType();
7733 break;
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00007734 case 'M':
7735 Type = Context.getObjCSuperType();
7736 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007737 case 'a':
7738 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
7739 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
7740 break;
7741 case 'A':
7742 // This is a "reference" to a va_list; however, what exactly
7743 // this means depends on how va_list is defined. There are two
7744 // different kinds of va_list: ones passed by value, and ones
7745 // passed by reference. An example of a by-value va_list is
7746 // x86, where va_list is a char*. An example of by-ref va_list
7747 // is x86-64, where va_list is a __va_list_tag[1]. For x86,
7748 // we want this argument to be a char*&; for x86-64, we want
7749 // it to be a __va_list_tag*.
7750 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
7751 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007752 if (Type->isArrayType())
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007753 Type = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Type);
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007754 else
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007755 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007756 break;
7757 case 'V': {
7758 char *End;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007759 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7760 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007761 Str = End;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007762
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007763 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error,
7764 RequiresICE, false);
7765 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE");
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007766
7767 // TODO: No way to make AltiVec vectors in builtins yet.
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00007768 Type = Context.getVectorType(ElementType, NumElements,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00007769 VectorType::GenericVector);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007770 break;
7771 }
Douglas Gregorfed66992012-06-07 18:08:25 +00007772 case 'E': {
7773 char *End;
7774
7775 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7776 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
7777
7778 Str = End;
7779
7780 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
7781 false);
7782 Type = Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, NumElements);
7783 break;
7784 }
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00007785 case 'X': {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007786 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
7787 false);
7788 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require complex ICE");
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00007789 Type = Context.getComplexType(ElementType);
7790 break;
Fariborz Jahanian73952fc2011-08-23 23:33:09 +00007791 }
7792 case 'Y' : {
7793 Type = Context.getPointerDiffType();
7794 break;
7795 }
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00007796 case 'P':
Douglas Gregor27821ce2009-07-07 16:35:42 +00007797 Type = Context.getFILEType();
7798 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007799 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007800 return QualType();
7801 }
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007802 break;
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00007803 case 'J':
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007804 if (Signed)
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00007805 Type = Context.getsigjmp_bufType();
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007806 else
7807 Type = Context.getjmp_bufType();
7808
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007809 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007810 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp;
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007811 return QualType();
7812 }
7813 break;
Rafael Espindola6cfa82b2011-11-13 21:51:09 +00007814 case 'K':
7815 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'K'!");
7816 Type = Context.getucontext_tType();
7817
7818 if (Type.isNull()) {
7819 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext;
7820 return QualType();
7821 }
7822 break;
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00007823 case 'p':
7824 Type = Context.getProcessIDType();
7825 break;
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00007826 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007827
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007828 // If there are modifiers and if we're allowed to parse them, go for it.
7829 Done = !AllowTypeModifiers;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007830 while (!Done) {
John McCallb8b94662010-03-12 04:21:28 +00007831 switch (char c = *Str++) {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007832 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
7833 case '*':
7834 case '&': {
7835 // Both pointers and references can have their pointee types
7836 // qualified with an address space.
7837 char *End;
7838 unsigned AddrSpace = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7839 if (End != Str && AddrSpace != 0) {
7840 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, AddrSpace);
7841 Str = End;
7842 }
7843 if (c == '*')
7844 Type = Context.getPointerType(Type);
7845 else
7846 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
7847 break;
7848 }
7849 // FIXME: There's no way to have a built-in with an rvalue ref arg.
7850 case 'C':
7851 Type = Type.withConst();
7852 break;
7853 case 'D':
7854 Type = Context.getVolatileType(Type);
7855 break;
Ted Kremenekf2a2f5f2012-01-20 21:40:12 +00007856 case 'R':
7857 Type = Type.withRestrict();
7858 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007859 }
7860 }
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007861
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007862 assert((!RequiresICE || Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) &&
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007863 "Integer constant 'I' type must be an integer");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007864
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007865 return Type;
7866}
7867
7868/// GetBuiltinType - Return the type for the specified builtin.
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007869QualType ASTContext::GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007870 GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007871 unsigned *IntegerConstantArgs) const {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007872 const char *TypeStr = BuiltinInfo.GetTypeString(Id);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007873
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007874 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007875
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007876 bool RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007877 Error = GE_None;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007878 QualType ResType = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error,
7879 RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007880 if (Error != GE_None)
7881 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007882
7883 assert(!RequiresICE && "Result of intrinsic cannot be required to be an ICE");
7884
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007885 while (TypeStr[0] && TypeStr[0] != '.') {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007886 QualType Ty = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007887 if (Error != GE_None)
7888 return QualType();
7889
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007890 // If this argument is required to be an IntegerConstantExpression and the
7891 // caller cares, fill in the bitmask we return.
7892 if (RequiresICE && IntegerConstantArgs)
7893 *IntegerConstantArgs |= 1 << ArgTypes.size();
7894
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007895 // Do array -> pointer decay. The builtin should use the decayed type.
7896 if (Ty->isArrayType())
7897 Ty = getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007898
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007899 ArgTypes.push_back(Ty);
7900 }
7901
David Majnemerba3e5ec2015-03-13 18:26:17 +00007902 if (Id == Builtin::BI__GetExceptionInfo)
7903 return QualType();
7904
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007905 assert((TypeStr[0] != '.' || TypeStr[1] == 0) &&
7906 "'.' should only occur at end of builtin type list!");
7907
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007908 FunctionType::ExtInfo EI(CC_C);
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00007909 if (BuiltinInfo.isNoReturn(Id)) EI = EI.withNoReturn(true);
7910
7911 bool Variadic = (TypeStr[0] == '.');
7912
7913 // We really shouldn't be making a no-proto type here, especially in C++.
7914 if (ArgTypes.empty() && Variadic)
7915 return getFunctionNoProtoType(ResType, EI);
Douglas Gregor36c569f2010-02-21 22:15:06 +00007916
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007917 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00007918 EPI.ExtInfo = EI;
7919 EPI.Variadic = Variadic;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007920
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00007921 return getFunctionType(ResType, ArgTypes, EPI);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007922}
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00007923
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007924static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForFunction(const ASTContext &Context,
7925 const FunctionDecl *FD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007926 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007927 return GVA_Internal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007928
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007929 GVALinkage External = GVA_StrongExternal;
7930 switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
7931 case TSK_Undeclared:
7932 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
7933 External = GVA_StrongExternal;
7934 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007935
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007936 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00007937 return GVA_StrongODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007938
David Majnemerc3d07332014-05-15 06:25:57 +00007939 // C++11 [temp.explicit]p10:
7940 // [ Note: The intent is that an inline function that is the subject of
7941 // an explicit instantiation declaration will still be implicitly
7942 // instantiated when used so that the body can be considered for
7943 // inlining, but that no out-of-line copy of the inline function would be
7944 // generated in the translation unit. -- end note ]
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007945 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007946 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
7947
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007948 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007949 External = GVA_DiscardableODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007950 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007951 }
7952
7953 if (!FD->isInlined())
7954 return External;
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00007955
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007956 if ((!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !Context.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat &&
7957 !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) ||
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00007958 FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007959 // FIXME: This doesn't match gcc's behavior for dllexport inline functions.
7960
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007961 // GNU or C99 inline semantics. Determine whether this symbol should be
7962 // externally visible.
7963 if (FD->isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible())
7964 return External;
7965
7966 // C99 inline semantics, where the symbol is not externally visible.
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007967 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007968 }
7969
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00007970 // Functions specified with extern and inline in -fms-compatibility mode
7971 // forcibly get emitted. While the body of the function cannot be later
7972 // replaced, the function definition cannot be discarded.
David Majnemer73768702015-03-20 00:02:27 +00007973 if (FD->isMSExternInline())
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00007974 return GVA_StrongODR;
7975
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007976 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007977}
7978
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007979static GVALinkage adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(GVALinkage L, const Decl *D) {
7980 // See http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/xa0d9ste.aspx
7981 // dllexport/dllimport on inline functions.
7982 if (D->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>()) {
7983 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_StrongODR)
7984 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
7985 } else if (D->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) {
7986 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR)
7987 return GVA_StrongODR;
7988 }
7989 return L;
7990}
7991
7992GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD) const {
7993 return adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(basicGVALinkageForFunction(*this, FD),
7994 FD);
7995}
7996
7997static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForVariable(const ASTContext &Context,
7998 const VarDecl *VD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007999 if (!VD->isExternallyVisible())
8000 return GVA_Internal;
8001
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008002 if (VD->isStaticLocal()) {
8003 GVALinkage StaticLocalLinkage = GVA_DiscardableODR;
8004 const DeclContext *LexicalContext = VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod();
8005 while (LexicalContext && !isa<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext))
8006 LexicalContext = LexicalContext->getLexicalParent();
8007
Richard Smith9e2341d2015-03-23 03:25:59 +00008008 // Let the static local variable inherit its linkage from the nearest
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008009 // enclosing function.
8010 if (LexicalContext)
8011 StaticLocalLinkage =
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008012 Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(cast<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext));
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008013
8014 // GVA_StrongODR function linkage is stronger than what we need,
8015 // downgrade to GVA_DiscardableODR.
8016 // This allows us to discard the variable if we never end up needing it.
8017 return StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_StrongODR ? GVA_DiscardableODR
8018 : StaticLocalLinkage;
8019 }
8020
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00008021 // MSVC treats in-class initialized static data members as definitions.
8022 // By giving them non-strong linkage, out-of-line definitions won't
8023 // cause link errors.
8024 if (Context.isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
8025 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
8026
Richard Smith8809a0c2013-09-27 20:14:12 +00008027 switch (VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008028 case TSK_Undeclared:
8029 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
8030 return GVA_StrongExternal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008031
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008032 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00008033 return GVA_StrongODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008034
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008035 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
8036 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
8037
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008038 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008039 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008040 }
Rafael Espindola27699c82013-05-13 14:05:53 +00008041
8042 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Linkage!");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008043}
8044
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008045GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl *VD) {
8046 return adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(basicGVALinkageForVariable(*this, VD),
8047 VD);
8048}
8049
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc9049332010-07-29 20:08:05 +00008050bool ASTContext::DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl *D) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008051 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
8052 if (!VD->isFileVarDecl())
8053 return false;
Renato Golin9258aa52014-05-21 10:40:27 +00008054 // Global named register variables (GNU extension) are never emitted.
8055 if (VD->getStorageClass() == SC_Register)
8056 return false;
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00008057 } else if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
8058 // We never need to emit an uninstantiated function template.
8059 if (FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
8060 return false;
Alexey Bataev97720002014-11-11 04:05:39 +00008061 } else if (isa<OMPThreadPrivateDecl>(D))
8062 return true;
8063 else
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00008064 return false;
8065
8066 // If this is a member of a class template, we do not need to emit it.
8067 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008068 return false;
8069
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00008070 // Weak references don't produce any output by themselves.
8071 if (D->hasAttr<WeakRefAttr>())
8072 return false;
8073
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008074 // Aliases and used decls are required.
8075 if (D->hasAttr<AliasAttr>() || D->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
8076 return true;
8077
8078 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
8079 // Forward declarations aren't required.
Alexis Hunt4a8ea102011-05-06 20:44:56 +00008080 if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
Nick Lewycky26da4dd2011-07-18 05:26:13 +00008081 return FD->doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008082
8083 // Constructors and destructors are required.
8084 if (FD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>() || FD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>())
8085 return true;
8086
John McCall6bd2a892013-01-25 22:31:03 +00008087 // The key function for a class is required. This rule only comes
8088 // into play when inline functions can be key functions, though.
8089 if (getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
8090 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
8091 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = MD->getParent();
8092 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && RD->isDynamicClass()) {
8093 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunc = getCurrentKeyFunction(RD);
8094 if (KeyFunc && KeyFunc->getCanonicalDecl() == MD->getCanonicalDecl())
8095 return true;
8096 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008097 }
8098 }
8099
8100 GVALinkage Linkage = GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD);
8101
8102 // static, static inline, always_inline, and extern inline functions can
8103 // always be deferred. Normal inline functions can be deferred in C99/C++.
8104 // Implicit template instantiations can also be deferred in C++.
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008105 if (Linkage == GVA_Internal || Linkage == GVA_AvailableExternally ||
8106 Linkage == GVA_DiscardableODR)
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008107 return false;
8108 return true;
8109 }
Douglas Gregor87d81242011-09-10 00:22:34 +00008110
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008111 const VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(D);
8112 assert(VD->isFileVarDecl() && "Expected file scoped var");
8113
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00008114 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly &&
8115 !isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00008116 return false;
8117
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008118 // Variables that can be needed in other TUs are required.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008119 GVALinkage L = GetGVALinkageForVariable(VD);
David Majnemerc3d07332014-05-15 06:25:57 +00008120 if (L != GVA_Internal && L != GVA_AvailableExternally &&
8121 L != GVA_DiscardableODR)
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008122 return true;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008123
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008124 // Variables that have destruction with side-effects are required.
8125 if (VD->getType().isDestructedType())
8126 return true;
8127
8128 // Variables that have initialization with side-effects are required.
8129 if (VD->getInit() && VD->getInit()->HasSideEffects(*this))
8130 return true;
8131
8132 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008133}
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00008134
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00008135CallingConv ASTContext::getDefaultCallingConvention(bool IsVariadic,
8136 bool IsCXXMethod) const {
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00008137 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00008138 if (IsCXXMethod)
8139 return ABI->getDefaultMethodCallConv(IsVariadic);
Timur Iskhodzhanovc5098ad2012-07-12 09:50:54 +00008140
Alexander Kornienko21de0ae2015-01-20 11:20:41 +00008141 if (LangOpts.MRTD && !IsVariadic) return CC_X86StdCall;
8142
8143 return Target->getDefaultCallingConv(TargetInfo::CCMT_Unknown);
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00008144}
8145
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00008146bool ASTContext::isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
Anders Carlsson60a62632010-11-25 01:51:53 +00008147 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
8148 return ABI->isNearlyEmpty(RD);
8149}
8150
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +00008151VTableContextBase *ASTContext::getVTableContext() {
8152 if (!VTContext.get()) {
8153 if (Target->getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
8154 VTContext.reset(new MicrosoftVTableContext(*this));
8155 else
8156 VTContext.reset(new ItaniumVTableContext(*this));
8157 }
8158 return VTContext.get();
8159}
8160
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00008161MangleContext *ASTContext::createMangleContext() {
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008162 switch (Target->getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00008163 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008164 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
8165 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
Zoran Jovanovic26a12162015-02-18 15:21:35 +00008166 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008167 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +00008168 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00008169 return ItaniumMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008170 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00008171 return MicrosoftMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00008172 }
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008173 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI");
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00008174}
8175
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00008176CXXABI::~CXXABI() {}
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00008177
8178size_t ASTContext::getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const {
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00008179 return ASTRecordLayouts.getMemorySize() +
8180 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCLayouts) +
8181 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(KeyFunctions) +
8182 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCImpls) +
8183 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(BlockVarCopyInits) +
8184 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(DeclAttrs) +
8185 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(TemplateOrInstantiation) +
8186 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingDecl) +
8187 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl) +
8188 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl) +
8189 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(OverriddenMethods) +
8190 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(Types) +
8191 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(VariableArrayTypes) +
8192 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ClassScopeSpecializationPattern);
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00008193}
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00008194
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00008195/// getIntTypeForBitwidth -
8196/// sets integer QualTy according to specified details:
8197/// bitwidth, signed/unsigned.
8198/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8199QualType ASTContext::getIntTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,
8200 unsigned Signed) const {
8201 TargetInfo::IntType Ty = getTargetInfo().getIntTypeByWidth(DestWidth, Signed);
8202 CanQualType QualTy = getFromTargetType(Ty);
8203 if (!QualTy && DestWidth == 128)
8204 return Signed ? Int128Ty : UnsignedInt128Ty;
8205 return QualTy;
8206}
8207
8208/// getRealTypeForBitwidth -
8209/// sets floating point QualTy according to specified bitwidth.
8210/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8211QualType ASTContext::getRealTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth) const {
8212 TargetInfo::RealType Ty = getTargetInfo().getRealTypeByWidth(DestWidth);
8213 switch (Ty) {
8214 case TargetInfo::Float:
8215 return FloatTy;
8216 case TargetInfo::Double:
8217 return DoubleTy;
8218 case TargetInfo::LongDouble:
8219 return LongDoubleTy;
8220 case TargetInfo::NoFloat:
8221 return QualType();
8222 }
8223
8224 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::RealType value");
8225}
8226
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008227void ASTContext::setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND, unsigned Number) {
8228 if (Number > 1)
8229 MangleNumbers[ND] = Number;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00008230}
8231
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008232unsigned ASTContext::getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND) const {
8233 llvm::DenseMap<const NamedDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8234 MangleNumbers.find(ND);
8235 return I != MangleNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00008236}
8237
David Majnemer2206bf52014-03-05 08:57:59 +00008238void ASTContext::setStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD, unsigned Number) {
8239 if (Number > 1)
8240 StaticLocalNumbers[VD] = Number;
8241}
8242
8243unsigned ASTContext::getStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD) const {
8244 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8245 StaticLocalNumbers.find(VD);
8246 return I != StaticLocalNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
8247}
8248
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008249MangleNumberingContext &
8250ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext *DC) {
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00008251 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus); // We don't need mangling numbers for plain C.
8252 MangleNumberingContext *&MCtx = MangleNumberingContexts[DC];
8253 if (!MCtx)
8254 MCtx = createMangleNumberingContext();
8255 return *MCtx;
8256}
8257
8258MangleNumberingContext *ASTContext::createMangleNumberingContext() const {
8259 return ABI->createMangleNumberingContext();
Douglas Gregor63798542012-02-20 19:44:39 +00008260}
8261
David Majnemere7a818f2015-03-06 18:53:55 +00008262const CXXConstructorDecl *
8263ASTContext::getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD) {
8264 return ABI->getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
8265 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()));
8266}
8267
8268void ASTContext::addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD,
8269 CXXConstructorDecl *CD) {
8270 return ABI->addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
8271 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()),
8272 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()));
8273}
8274
David Majnemerdfa6d202015-03-11 18:36:39 +00008275void ASTContext::addDefaultArgExprForConstructor(const CXXConstructorDecl *CD,
8276 unsigned ParmIdx, Expr *DAE) {
8277 ABI->addDefaultArgExprForConstructor(
8278 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()), ParmIdx, DAE);
8279}
8280
8281Expr *ASTContext::getDefaultArgExprForConstructor(const CXXConstructorDecl *CD,
8282 unsigned ParmIdx) {
8283 return ABI->getDefaultArgExprForConstructor(
8284 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()), ParmIdx);
8285}
8286
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00008287void ASTContext::setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D, unsigned int index) {
8288 ParamIndices[D] = index;
8289}
8290
8291unsigned ASTContext::getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D) const {
8292 ParameterIndexTable::const_iterator I = ParamIndices.find(D);
8293 assert(I != ParamIndices.end() &&
8294 "ParmIndices lacks entry set by ParmVarDecl");
8295 return I->second;
8296}
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008297
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00008298APValue *
8299ASTContext::getMaterializedTemporaryValue(const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *E,
8300 bool MayCreate) {
8301 assert(E && E->getStorageDuration() == SD_Static &&
8302 "don't need to cache the computed value for this temporary");
8303 if (MayCreate)
8304 return &MaterializedTemporaryValues[E];
8305
8306 llvm::DenseMap<const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *, APValue>::iterator I =
8307 MaterializedTemporaryValues.find(E);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00008308 return I == MaterializedTemporaryValues.end() ? nullptr : &I->second;
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00008309}
8310
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008311bool ASTContext::AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr *E) const {
8312 const llvm::Triple &T = getTargetInfo().getTriple();
8313 if (!T.isOSDarwin())
8314 return false;
8315
Bob Wilson2c82c3d2013-11-02 23:27:49 +00008316 if (!(T.isiOS() && T.isOSVersionLT(7)) &&
8317 !(T.isMacOSX() && T.isOSVersionLT(10, 9)))
8318 return false;
8319
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008320 QualType AtomicTy = E->getPtr()->getType()->getPointeeType();
8321 CharUnits sizeChars = getTypeSizeInChars(AtomicTy);
8322 uint64_t Size = sizeChars.getQuantity();
8323 CharUnits alignChars = getTypeAlignInChars(AtomicTy);
8324 unsigned Align = alignChars.getQuantity();
8325 unsigned MaxInlineWidthInBits = getTargetInfo().getMaxAtomicInlineWidth();
8326 return (Size != Align || toBits(sizeChars) > MaxInlineWidthInBits);
8327}
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008328
8329namespace {
8330
8331 /// \brief A \c RecursiveASTVisitor that builds a map from nodes to their
8332 /// parents as defined by the \c RecursiveASTVisitor.
8333 ///
8334 /// Note that the relationship described here is purely in terms of AST
8335 /// traversal - there are other relationships (for example declaration context)
8336 /// in the AST that are better modeled by special matchers.
8337 ///
8338 /// FIXME: Currently only builds up the map using \c Stmt and \c Decl nodes.
8339 class ParentMapASTVisitor : public RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> {
8340
8341 public:
8342 /// \brief Builds and returns the translation unit's parent map.
8343 ///
8344 /// The caller takes ownership of the returned \c ParentMap.
8345 static ASTContext::ParentMap *buildMap(TranslationUnitDecl &TU) {
8346 ParentMapASTVisitor Visitor(new ASTContext::ParentMap);
8347 Visitor.TraverseDecl(&TU);
8348 return Visitor.Parents;
8349 }
8350
8351 private:
8352 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> VisitorBase;
8353
8354 ParentMapASTVisitor(ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents) : Parents(Parents) {
8355 }
8356
8357 bool shouldVisitTemplateInstantiations() const {
8358 return true;
8359 }
8360 bool shouldVisitImplicitCode() const {
8361 return true;
8362 }
8363 // Disables data recursion. We intercept Traverse* methods in the RAV, which
8364 // are not triggered during data recursion.
8365 bool shouldUseDataRecursionFor(clang::Stmt *S) const {
8366 return false;
8367 }
8368
8369 template <typename T>
8370 bool TraverseNode(T *Node, bool(VisitorBase:: *traverse) (T *)) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00008371 if (!Node)
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008372 return true;
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008373 if (ParentStack.size() > 0) {
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00008374 // FIXME: Currently we add the same parent multiple times, but only
8375 // when no memoization data is available for the type.
8376 // For example when we visit all subexpressions of template
8377 // instantiations; this is suboptimal, but benign: the only way to
8378 // visit those is with hasAncestor / hasParent, and those do not create
8379 // new matches.
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008380 // The plan is to enable DynTypedNode to be storable in a map or hash
8381 // map. The main problem there is to implement hash functions /
8382 // comparison operators for all types that DynTypedNode supports that
8383 // do not have pointer identity.
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008384 auto &NodeOrVector = (*Parents)[Node];
8385 if (NodeOrVector.isNull()) {
8386 NodeOrVector = new ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008387 } else {
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00008388 if (NodeOrVector.template is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
8389 auto *Node =
8390 NodeOrVector.template get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
8391 auto *Vector = new ASTContext::ParentVector(1, *Node);
8392 NodeOrVector = Vector;
8393 delete Node;
8394 }
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008395 assert(NodeOrVector.template is<ASTContext::ParentVector *>());
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00008396
8397 auto *Vector =
8398 NodeOrVector.template get<ASTContext::ParentVector *>();
8399 // Skip duplicates for types that have memoization data.
8400 // We must check that the type has memoization data before calling
8401 // std::find() because DynTypedNode::operator== can't compare all
8402 // types.
8403 bool Found = ParentStack.back().getMemoizationData() &&
8404 std::find(Vector->begin(), Vector->end(),
8405 ParentStack.back()) != Vector->end();
8406 if (!Found)
8407 Vector->push_back(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008408 }
8409 }
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008410 ParentStack.push_back(ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*Node));
8411 bool Result = (this ->* traverse) (Node);
8412 ParentStack.pop_back();
8413 return Result;
8414 }
8415
8416 bool TraverseDecl(Decl *DeclNode) {
8417 return TraverseNode(DeclNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseDecl);
8418 }
8419
8420 bool TraverseStmt(Stmt *StmtNode) {
8421 return TraverseNode(StmtNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseStmt);
8422 }
8423
8424 ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents;
8425 llvm::SmallVector<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode, 16> ParentStack;
8426
8427 friend class RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor>;
8428 };
8429
8430} // end namespace
8431
Benjamin Kramer07935292014-10-04 17:01:26 +00008432ArrayRef<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode>
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008433ASTContext::getParents(const ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode &Node) {
8434 assert(Node.getMemoizationData() &&
8435 "Invariant broken: only nodes that support memoization may be "
8436 "used in the parent map.");
8437 if (!AllParents) {
8438 // We always need to run over the whole translation unit, as
8439 // hasAncestor can escape any subtree.
8440 AllParents.reset(
8441 ParentMapASTVisitor::buildMap(*getTranslationUnitDecl()));
8442 }
8443 ParentMap::const_iterator I = AllParents->find(Node.getMemoizationData());
8444 if (I == AllParents->end()) {
Benjamin Kramer07935292014-10-04 17:01:26 +00008445 return None;
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008446 }
Benjamin Kramer07935292014-10-04 17:01:26 +00008447 if (auto *N = I->second.dyn_cast<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
8448 return llvm::makeArrayRef(N, 1);
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008449 }
Benjamin Kramer07935292014-10-04 17:01:26 +00008450 return *I->second.get<ParentVector *>();
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008451}
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00008452
8453bool
8454ASTContext::ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodDecl,
8455 const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodImpl) {
8456 // No point trying to match an unavailable/deprecated mothod.
8457 if (MethodDecl->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()
8458 || MethodDecl->hasAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
8459 return false;
8460 if (MethodDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier() !=
8461 MethodImpl->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8462 return false;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008463 if (!hasSameType(MethodDecl->getReturnType(), MethodImpl->getReturnType()))
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00008464 return false;
8465
8466 if (MethodDecl->param_size() != MethodImpl->param_size())
8467 return false;
8468
8469 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator IM = MethodImpl->param_begin(),
8470 IF = MethodDecl->param_begin(), EM = MethodImpl->param_end(),
8471 EF = MethodDecl->param_end();
8472 IM != EM && IF != EF; ++IM, ++IF) {
8473 const ParmVarDecl *DeclVar = (*IF);
8474 const ParmVarDecl *ImplVar = (*IM);
8475 if (ImplVar->getObjCDeclQualifier() != DeclVar->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8476 return false;
8477 if (!hasSameType(DeclVar->getType(), ImplVar->getType()))
8478 return false;
8479 }
8480 return (MethodDecl->isVariadic() == MethodImpl->isVariadic());
8481
8482}
Richard Smith053f6c62014-05-16 23:01:30 +00008483
8484// Explicitly instantiate this in case a Redeclarable<T> is used from a TU that
8485// doesn't include ASTContext.h
8486template
8487clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
8488 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::ValueType
8489clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
8490 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::makeValue(
8491 const clang::ASTContext &Ctx, Decl *Value);